blob: 030a9a6604f1ccfd15567eea7eb4f786b981015b [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau6b07bf72013-12-17 00:45:49 +01007 2013/12/17
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
727.3.1. Fetching samples from internal states
737.3.2. Fetching samples at Layer 4
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 5
757.3.4. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
767.3.5. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
777.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078
798. Logging
808.1. Log levels
818.2. Log formats
828.2.1. Default log format
838.2.2. TCP log format
848.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100858.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100868.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200878.3. Advanced logging options
888.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
898.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
908.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
918.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
928.4. Timing events
938.5. Session state at disconnection
948.6. Non-printable characters
958.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
968.8. Capturing HTTP headers
978.9. Examples of logs
98
999. Statistics and monitoring
1009.1. CSV format
1019.2. Unix Socket commands
102
103
1041. Quick reminder about HTTP
105----------------------------
106
107When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
108fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
109on almost anything found in the contents.
110
111However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
112formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
113correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
114
115
1161.1. The HTTP transaction model
117-------------------------------
118
119The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100120to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
122connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
123will involve a new connection :
124
125 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
126
127In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
128establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
129by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
130length.
131
132Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
133to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
134however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
135response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
136header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
137
138 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
139
140Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
141power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
142but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200143a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200144
145A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
146keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
147second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
148page :
149
150 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
151
152This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
153latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
154correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
155the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100156server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200158By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
159connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
160everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
161established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
162sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
163while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
164another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
165sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
166http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
167mode.
168
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169
1701.2. HTTP request
171-----------------
172
173First, let's consider this HTTP request :
174
175 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100176 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
178 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
179 3 User-agent: my small browser
180 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
181 5 Accept: image/png
182
183
1841.2.1. The Request line
185-----------------------
186
187Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
188
189 - a METHOD : GET
190 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
191 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
192
193All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
194which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
195followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
196is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
197desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
198the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
199
200The URI itself can have several forms :
201
202 - A "relative URI" :
203
204 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
205
206 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
207 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
208
209 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
210
211 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
212
213 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
214 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
215 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
216 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
217 must accept this form too.
218
219 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
220 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
221 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100222
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200223 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
224 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
225 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
226 other protocols too.
227
228In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
229mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
230on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
231It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
232specific to the language, framework or application in use.
233
234
2351.2.2. The request headers
236--------------------------
237
238The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
239beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
240an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
241Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
242values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
243encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
244the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
245define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
246
247Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
248their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
249"Connection:" header).
250
251The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
252that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
253is one valid form of empty line.
254
255Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
256headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
257about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
258application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
259
260Important note:
261 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
262 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
263 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
264 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
265
266
2671.3. HTTP response
268------------------
269
270An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
271messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
272
273 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100274 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200275 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
276 2 Content-length: 350
277 3 Content-Type: text/html
278
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200279As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
280codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
281response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100282continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
283the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
284following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
285sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
286(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
287correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
288such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
289state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
290over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
291if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
292information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200293
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294
2951.3.1. The Response line
296------------------------
297
298Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
299
300 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
301 - a status code : 200
302 - a reason : OK
303
304The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200305 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200306 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
307 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
308 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
309 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
310
311Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100312"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200313found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
314messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
315or "Authentication Required".
316
317Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
318
319 Code When / reason
320 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
321 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
322 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
323 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100324 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200326 400 for an invalid or too large request
327 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
328 accessing the stats page)
329 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
330 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
331 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
332 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
333 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
334 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
335 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
336 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
337 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
338
339The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3404.2).
341
342
3431.3.2. The response headers
344---------------------------
345
346Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
347the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
348details.
349
350
3512. Configuring HAProxy
352----------------------
353
3542.1. Configuration file format
355------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200356
357HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
358
359 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
360 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
361 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
362 "frontend" and "backend".
363
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100364The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
365referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
366delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100367preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100368escaped by doubling them.
369
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200370
3712.2. Time format
372----------------
373
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100374Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100375values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
376otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
377numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
378for every keyword. Supported units are :
379
380 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
381 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
382 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
383 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
384 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
385 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
386
387
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003882.3. Examples
389-------------
390
391 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
392 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
393 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
394 global
395 daemon
396 maxconn 256
397
398 defaults
399 mode http
400 timeout connect 5000ms
401 timeout client 50000ms
402 timeout server 50000ms
403
404 frontend http-in
405 bind *:80
406 default_backend servers
407
408 backend servers
409 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
410
411
412 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
413 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
414 global
415 daemon
416 maxconn 256
417
418 defaults
419 mode http
420 timeout connect 5000ms
421 timeout client 50000ms
422 timeout server 50000ms
423
424 listen http-in
425 bind *:80
426 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
427
428
429Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
430
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100431 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432
433
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004343. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200435--------------------
436
437Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
438are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
439of them have command-line equivalents.
440
441The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
442
443 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200444 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200445 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200446 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200447 - daemon
448 - gid
449 - group
450 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100451 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200452 - nbproc
453 - pidfile
454 - uid
455 - ulimit-n
456 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200457 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200458 - node
459 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100460 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100461
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200462 * Performance tuning
463 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200464 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100465 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100466 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100467 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200468 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200469 - noepoll
470 - nokqueue
471 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100472 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200473 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200474 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200475 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100476 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100477 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200478 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100479 - tune.maxaccept
480 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200481 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200482 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100483 - tune.rcvbuf.client
484 - tune.rcvbuf.server
485 - tune.sndbuf.client
486 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100487 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100488 - tune.ssl.lifetime
489 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100490 - tune.zlib.memlevel
491 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100492
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200493 * Debugging
494 - debug
495 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200496
497
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004983.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200499------------------------------------
500
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200501ca-base <dir>
502 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200503 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
504 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200505
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200506chroot <jail dir>
507 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
508 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
509 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
510 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
511 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
512 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100513
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100514cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
515 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
516 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
517 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
518 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32,
519 and any process IDs above nbproc are ignored. It is possible to specify all
520 processes at once using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers
521 using "even", just like with the "bind-process" directive. The second and
522 forthcoming arguments are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number
523 between 0 and 31 or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-').
524 Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes will be
525 allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may
526 be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when
527 they overlap.
528
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200529crt-base <dir>
530 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
531 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
532 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
533
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200534daemon
535 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
536 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
537 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
538
539gid <number>
540 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
541 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
542 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100543 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
544 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200545 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100546
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547group <group name>
548 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
549 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100550
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200551log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200552 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
553 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100554 configured with "log global".
555
556 <address> can be one of:
557
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100558 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100559 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
560 port).
561
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100562 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
563 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
564 port).
565
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100566 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
567 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
568 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
569 writeable).
570
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100571 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
572 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
573 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
574 in Bourne shell.
575
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100576 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577
578 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
579 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
580 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
581
582 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200583 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
584 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
585 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
586 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
587 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
588 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200589
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200590 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200591
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100592log-send-hostname [<string>]
593 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
594 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
595 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
596 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
597 the logs.
598
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000599log-tag <string>
600 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
601 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
602 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
603 running on the same host.
604
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200605nbproc <number>
606 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
607 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
608 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
609 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
610 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
611
612pidfile <pidfile>
613 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
614 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
615 starting the process. See also "daemon".
616
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +0100617stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200618 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
619 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
620 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
621 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
622 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
623 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
624 the number of processes used.
625
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200626stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
627 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
628 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
629 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
630 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200631
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200632 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
633 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
634 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200635
636stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
637 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
638 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100639 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200640
641stats maxconn <connections>
642 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
643 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
644
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200645uid <number>
646 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
647 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
648 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
649 one. See also "gid" and "user".
650
651ulimit-n <number>
652 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
653 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
654 option.
655
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100656unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
657 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
658
659 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
660 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
661 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
662 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
663 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
664 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
665 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
666 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
667 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
668 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
669
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200670user <user name>
671 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
672 See also "uid" and "group".
673
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200674node <name>
675 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
676
677 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
678 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
679 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
680 traffic.
681
682description <text>
683 Add a text that describes the instance.
684
685 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
686 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
687 "<" and ">" characters.
688
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200689
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006903.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200691-----------------------
692
693maxconn <number>
694 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
695 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
696 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
697 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
698
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200699maxconnrate <number>
700 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
701 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
702 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
703 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
704 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
705 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
706 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
707 fairness.
708
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100709maxcomprate <number>
710 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
711 pers second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
712 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
713 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
714 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
715 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
716 default value.
717
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100718maxcompcpuusage <number>
719 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
720 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
721 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
722 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
723 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
724 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
725 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
726 process down and from introducing high latencies.
727
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100728maxpipes <number>
729 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
730 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
731 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
732 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
733 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
734 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
735
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200736maxsslconn <number>
737 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
738 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
739 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
740 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
741 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
742 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
743 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
744
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100745maxzlibmem <number>
746 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
747 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
748 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100749 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
750 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
751 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
752
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200753noepoll
754 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
755 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100756 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200757
758nokqueue
759 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
760 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
761 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
762
763nopoll
764 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
765 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100766 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100767 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200768
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100769nosplice
770 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
771 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
772 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100773 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100774 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
775 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
776 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
777 "option splice-response".
778
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200779spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900780 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
781 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
782 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
783 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
784 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
785 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200786
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200787tune.bufsize <number>
788 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
789 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
790 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
791 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
792 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
793 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
794 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
795 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400796 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
797 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
798 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200799
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200800tune.chksize <number>
801 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
802 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
803 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
804 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
805 checks whenever possible.
806
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100807tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
808 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
809 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
810 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
811 this value. The default value is 1.
812
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100813tune.http.cookielen <number>
814 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
815 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
816 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
817 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
818 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
819 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
820 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
821 to change this value.
822
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200823tune.http.maxhdr <number>
824 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
825 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
826 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
827 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
828 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
829 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
830 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
831 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
832 limit too high.
833
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100834tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100835 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
836 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
837 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
838 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
839 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
840 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
841 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
842 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
843 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
844 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100845
846tune.maxpollevents <number>
847 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
848 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
849 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
850 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
851 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
852
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200853tune.maxrewrite <number>
854 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
855 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
856 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
857 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
858 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
859 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
860 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
861 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
862 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
863 bufsize.
864
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200865tune.pipesize <number>
866 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
867 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
868 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
869 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
870 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
871 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
872
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100873tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
874tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
875 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
876 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
877 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
878 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
879 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
880 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
881 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
882
883tune.sndbuf.client <number>
884tune.sndbuf.server <number>
885 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
886 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
887 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
888 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
889 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
890 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
891 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
892 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
893 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
894 notifying haproxy again.
895
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100896tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100897 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
898 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
899 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
900 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block use approximatively
901 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
902 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
903 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
904 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
905 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +0100906 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
907 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100908
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100909tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
910 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
911 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 mn). It is important to understand that it
912 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
913 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
914 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
915 being used for too long.
916
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100917tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
918 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
919 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
920 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
921 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
922 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
923 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
924 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
925 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
926 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
927 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
928 best value.
929
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100930tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
931 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
932 defines how much memory should be allocated for the intenal compression
933 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
934 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
935 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
936
937tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
938 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
939 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
940 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
941 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200942
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009433.3. Debugging
944--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200945
946debug
947 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
948 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
949 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
950 system startup.
951
952quiet
953 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
954 line argument "-q".
955
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200956
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01009573.4. Userlists
958--------------
959It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
960http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
961it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
962
963userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100964 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100965 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
966
967group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100968 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100969 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
970 proceeded by "users" keyword.
971
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100972user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
973 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100974 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
975 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100976 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
977 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100978 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
979 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
980
981
982 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100983 userlist L1
984 group G1 users tiger,scott
985 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100986
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100987 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
988 user scott insecure-password elgato
989 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100990
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100991 userlist L2
992 group G1
993 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100994
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100995 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
996 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
997 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100998
999 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001000
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001001
10023.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001003----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001004It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1005haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1006pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1007identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1008or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1009Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1010known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1011the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1012process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1013during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1014tables.
1015
1016peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001017 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001018 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1019
1020peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1021 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1022 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1023 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1024 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1025 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1026 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1027
1028 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1029 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1030
1031 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1032 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1033 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1034 across all peers.
1035
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001036 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1037 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1038 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1039
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001040 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001041 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001042 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1043 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1044 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001045
1046 backend mybackend
1047 mode tcp
1048 balance roundrobin
1049 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1050 stick on src
1051
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001052 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1053 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001054
1055
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010564. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001057----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001058
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001059Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1060 - defaults <name>
1061 - frontend <name>
1062 - backend <name>
1063 - listen <name>
1064
1065A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1066its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1067section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001068section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001069
1070A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1071connections.
1072
1073A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1074to forward incoming connections.
1075
1076A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1077parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1078
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001079All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1080'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1081case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1082
1083Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1084logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1085proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1086However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1087name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1088
1089Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1090and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001091bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001092protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1093modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1094arbitrary criteria.
1095
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001096
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010974.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1098--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001099
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001100The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1101limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1102they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1103limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001104marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001105option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001106and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1107with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1108specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001109
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001110
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001111 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1112------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1113acl - X X X
1114appsession - - X X
1115backlog X X X -
1116balance X - X X
1117bind - X X -
1118bind-process X X X X
1119block - X X X
1120capture cookie - X X -
1121capture request header - X X -
1122capture response header - X X -
1123clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001124compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001125contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1126cookie X - X X
1127default-server X - X X
1128default_backend X X X -
1129description - X X X
1130disabled X X X X
1131dispatch - - X X
1132enabled X X X X
1133errorfile X X X X
1134errorloc X X X X
1135errorloc302 X X X X
1136-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1137errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001138force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001139fullconn X - X X
1140grace X X X X
1141hash-type X - X X
1142http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001143http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001144http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001145http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001146http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02001147tcp-check expect - - X X
1148tcp-check send - - X X
1149tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001150http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001151id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001152ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001153log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001154maxconn X X X -
1155mode X X X X
1156monitor fail - X X -
1157monitor-net X X X -
1158monitor-uri X X X -
1159option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1160option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1161option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1162option allbackups (*) X - X X
1163option checkcache (*) X - X X
1164option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1165option contstats (*) X X X -
1166option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1167option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1168option forceclose (*) X X X X
1169-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1170option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001171option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001172option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001173option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001174option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1175option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1176option httpchk X - X X
1177option httpclose (*) X X X X
1178option httplog X X X X
1179option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001180option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001181option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001182option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1183option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1184option logasap (*) X X X -
1185option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001186option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001187option nolinger (*) X X X X
1188option originalto X X X X
1189option persist (*) X - X X
1190option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001191option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001192option smtpchk X - X X
1193option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1194option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1195option splice-request (*) X X X X
1196option splice-response (*) X X X X
1197option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1198option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1199-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001200option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001201option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1202option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1203option tcpka X X X X
1204option tcplog X X X X
1205option transparent (*) X - X X
1206persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1207rate-limit sessions X X X -
1208redirect - X X X
1209redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1210redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1211reqadd - X X X
1212reqallow - X X X
1213reqdel - X X X
1214reqdeny - X X X
1215reqiallow - X X X
1216reqidel - X X X
1217reqideny - X X X
1218reqipass - X X X
1219reqirep - X X X
1220reqisetbe - X X X
1221reqitarpit - X X X
1222reqpass - X X X
1223reqrep - X X X
1224-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1225reqsetbe - X X X
1226reqtarpit - X X X
1227retries X - X X
1228rspadd - X X X
1229rspdel - X X X
1230rspdeny - X X X
1231rspidel - X X X
1232rspideny - X X X
1233rspirep - X X X
1234rsprep - X X X
1235server - - X X
1236source X - X X
1237srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001238stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001239stats auth X - X X
1240stats enable X - X X
1241stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001242stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001243stats realm X - X X
1244stats refresh X - X X
1245stats scope X - X X
1246stats show-desc X - X X
1247stats show-legends X - X X
1248stats show-node X - X X
1249stats uri X - X X
1250-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1251stick match - - X X
1252stick on - - X X
1253stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001254stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001255stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001256tcp-request connection - X X -
1257tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001258tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001259tcp-response content - - X X
1260tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001261timeout check X - X X
1262timeout client X X X -
1263timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1264timeout connect X - X X
1265timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1266timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1267timeout http-request X X X X
1268timeout queue X - X X
1269timeout server X - X X
1270timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1271timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001272timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001273transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001274unique-id-format X X X -
1275unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001276use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001277use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001278------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1279 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001280
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001281
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012824.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1283---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001284
1285This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1286
1287
1288acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1289 Declare or complete an access list.
1290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1291 no | yes | yes | yes
1292 Example:
1293 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1294 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1295 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001297 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001298
1299
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001300appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1301 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001302 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1303 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1304 no | no | yes | yes
1305 Arguments :
1306 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1307 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1308
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001309 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001310 checked in each cookie value.
1311
1312 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1313 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1314 milliseconds.
1315
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001316 request-learn
1317 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1318 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1319 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1320 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1321 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1322 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1323
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001324 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1325 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1326 data following this prefix.
1327
1328 Example :
1329 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1330
1331 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1332 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1333
1334 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1335 2 modes are currently supported :
1336 - path-parameters :
1337 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1338 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1339 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1340 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1341 - query-string :
1342 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1343 query string.
1344
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001345 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1346 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1347 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1348 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001349 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1350 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1351 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001352 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1353 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1354
1355 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1356
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001357 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1358 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1359 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1360
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001361 Example :
1362 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1363
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001364 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1365 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001366
1367
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001368backlog <conns>
1369 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1370 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1371 yes | yes | yes | no
1372 Arguments :
1373 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1374 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001375 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001376
1377 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1378 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1379 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1380 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1381 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1382 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1383 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1384 backlog parameter.
1385
1386 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1387 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1388 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1389
1390 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1391
1392
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001393balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001394balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001395 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1397 yes | no | yes | yes
1398 Arguments :
1399 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1400 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1401 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1402 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1403
1404 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1405 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1406 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1407 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001408 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001409 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001410 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1411 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1412 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1413 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1414 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1415 it, so that you don't worry.
1416
1417 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1418 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1419 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1420 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1421 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1422 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1423 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1424 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001425
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001426 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1427 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1428 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1429 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1430 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1431 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1432 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1433 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1434
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001435 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1436 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1437 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1438 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001439 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001440 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1441 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1442 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1443 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1444 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001445 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1446 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1447 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1448 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1449 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1450 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001451
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001452 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1453 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1454 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1455 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1456 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1457 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1458 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1459 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001460 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001461 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001462 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1463 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1464 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001465
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001466 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1467 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1468 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1469 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1470 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1471 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1472 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1473 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1474 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1475 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1476 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1477 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001478
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001479 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001480 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1481 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1482 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1483 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1484 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1485 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1486 URIs start with a leading "/".
1487
1488 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1489 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1490 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1491 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1492
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001493 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001494 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1495
1496 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001497 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1498 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1499 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1500 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1501 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1502 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1503 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1504 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1505 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1506 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1507 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1508 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1509 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1510 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1511 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1512 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1513 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1514 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1515 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001516
1517 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1518 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1519 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1520 server will receive the request.
1521
1522 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1523 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1524 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1525 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1526 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001527 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1528 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1529 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001530
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001531 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1532 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1533 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1534 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1535 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001536
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001537 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001538 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1539 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1540 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1541
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001542 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1543 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1544 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1545
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001546 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001547 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001548 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1549 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1550 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1551 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1552 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1553 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001554 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001555 used instead.
1556
1557 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1558 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1559 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1560 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1561
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001562 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1563 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1564 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1565
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001566 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001567
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001568 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001569 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1570 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001571
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001572 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001573 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001574
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001575 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1576 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1577 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001578
1579 Examples :
1580 balance roundrobin
1581 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001582 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001583 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1584 balance hdr(host)
1585 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001586
1587 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1588 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1589
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001590 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001591 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1592 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1593 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1594 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1595
1596 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1597 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1598 defaults to 16 kB.
1599
1600 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1601 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1602
1603 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1604 Round Robin.
1605
1606 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1607 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1608 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1609 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1610
1611 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1612
1613 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001614 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001615 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1616 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1617 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001618
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001619 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1620 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001621
1622
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001623bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1624bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001625 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1627 no | yes | yes | no
1628 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001629 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1630 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1631 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1632 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001633 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001634 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1635 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1636 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1637 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1638 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1639 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1640 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001641 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1642 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1643 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001644 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1645 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1646 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1647 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001648
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001649 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1650 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001651 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1652 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1653 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001654 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1655 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1656 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1657 the range.
1658
1659 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1660 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1661 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1662 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1663 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1664 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1665 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001666 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001667 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001668
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001669 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1670 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1671 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1672 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1673 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1674 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1675 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1676 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1677
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001678 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1679 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1680 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1681 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001682
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001683 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1684 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1685 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1686 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1687 in a frontend.
1688
1689 Example :
1690 listen http_proxy
1691 bind :80,:443
1692 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001693 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001694
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001695 listen http_https_proxy
1696 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001697 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001698
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001699 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1700 bind ipv6@:80
1701 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1702 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1703
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001704 listen external_bind_app1
1705 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1706
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001707 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001708 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001709
1710
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001711bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001712 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1714 yes | yes | yes | yes
1715 Arguments :
1716 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1717 may be used to override a default value.
1718
1719 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1720 option may be combined with other numbers.
1721
1722 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1723 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1724 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1725 missing from all processes.
1726
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001727 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
1728 whose values must all be between 1 and 32. You must be
1729 careful not to reference a process number greater than the
1730 configured global.nbproc, otherwise some instances might be
1731 missing from all processes.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001732
1733 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1734 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1735 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1736 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1737 and 'even' instances.
1738
1739 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1740 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1741 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1742 32.
1743
1744 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1745 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1746
1747 Example :
1748 listen app_ip1
1749 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001750 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001751
1752 listen app_ip2
1753 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001754 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001755
1756 listen management
1757 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001758 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001759
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001760 listen management
1761 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1762 bind-process 1-4
1763
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001764 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1765
1766
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001767block { if | unless } <condition>
1768 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1770 no | yes | yes | yes
1771
1772 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1773 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001774 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001775 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001776 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1777 "block" statements per instance.
1778
1779 Example:
1780 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1781 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1782 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1783 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1784
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001785 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001786
1787
1788capture cookie <name> len <length>
1789 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1790 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1791 no | yes | yes | no
1792 Arguments :
1793 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1794 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1795 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1796 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1797 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1798
1799 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1800 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1801 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1802 right if it exceeds <length>.
1803
1804 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1805 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1806 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1807 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1808
1809 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1810 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1811 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1812
1813 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1814 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1815 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001816 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1817 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1818 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001819
1820 Example:
1821 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1822
1823 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001824 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001825
1826
1827capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001828 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001829 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1830 no | yes | yes | no
1831 Arguments :
1832 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001833 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001834 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1835 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1836 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1837
1838 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1839 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1840 it exceeds <length>.
1841
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001842 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001843 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1844 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001845 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1846 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1847 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1848 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001849 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001850 environments to find where the request came from.
1851
1852 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1853 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1854 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1855 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001856
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001857 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
1858 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1859 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1860 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1861 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001862
1863 Example:
1864 capture request header Host len 15
1865 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1866 capture request header Referrer len 15
1867
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001868 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001869 about logging.
1870
1871
1872capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001873 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1875 no | yes | yes | no
1876 Arguments :
1877 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001878 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001879 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1880 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1881 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1882
1883 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1884 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1885 it exceeds <length>.
1886
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001887 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001888 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1889 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1890 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001891 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1892 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1893 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1894 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001895
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001896 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
1897 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1898 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1899 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1900 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001901
1902 Example:
1903 capture response header Content-length len 9
1904 capture response header Location len 15
1905
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001906 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001907 about logging.
1908
1909
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001910clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001911 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1913 yes | yes | yes | no
1914 Arguments :
1915 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1916 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1917 as explained at the top of this document.
1918
1919 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1920 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1921 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1922 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1923 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1924 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1925 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1926 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001927 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001928 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1929 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1930
1931 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1932 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1933 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1934 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1935 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1936 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1937
1938 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1939 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1940
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001941 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1942 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001943
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001944compression algo <algorithm> ...
1945compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001946compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001947 Enable HTTP compression.
1948 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1949 yes | yes | yes | yes
1950 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001951 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
1952 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
1953 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
1954
1955 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04001956 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001957 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
1958 data.
1959
1960 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
1961 support for zlib was built in.
1962
1963 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
1964 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
1965 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
1966 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
1967 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
1968 in.
1969
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04001970 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001971 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04001972 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
1973 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
1974 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
1975 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
1976 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001977
1978 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
1979 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
1980 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
1981 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
1982 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04001983 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
1984 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
1985 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
1986 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
1987 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
1988 then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001989
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01001990 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01001991 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
1992 "Accept-Encoding" header
1993 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01001994 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01001995 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
1996 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01001997 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
1998 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
1999 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2000 "multipart"
2001 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2002 header
2003 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2004 and later
2005 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2006 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002007
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002008 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2009 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002010
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002011 Examples :
2012 compression algo gzip
2013 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002014
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002015contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002016 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2018 yes | no | yes | yes
2019 Arguments :
2020 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2021 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2022 as explained at the top of this document.
2023
2024 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002025 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002026 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002027 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2028 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2029 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2030 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2031
2032 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2033 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2034 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2035 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2036 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2037 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2038
2039 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2040 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2041 instead.
2042
2043 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2044 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2045
2046
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002047cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002048 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2049 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002050 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2052 yes | no | yes | yes
2053 Arguments :
2054 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2055 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2056 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2057 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2058 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2059 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2060 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2061 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2062 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2063
2064 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2065 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2066 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2067 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2068 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2069 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2070 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2071 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2072 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2073 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2074 "insert" and "prefix".
2075
2076 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002077 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002078
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002079 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002080 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2081 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2082 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2083 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2084 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2085 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2086 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2087 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2088 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2089 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002090
2091 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2092 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2093 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2094 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2095 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2096 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2097 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2098 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2099 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2100 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002101 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2102 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2103 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002104
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002105 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2106 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2107 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002108 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2109 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2110 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2111 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002112 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2113 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2114 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002115
2116 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2117 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2118 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2119 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2120 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2121 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2122 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2123 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2124 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2125
2126 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2127 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2128 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2129 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2130 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2131 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2132 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2133 persistence cookie in the cache.
2134 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2135
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002136 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2137 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2138 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2139 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2140 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2141 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2142 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2143 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2144 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2145 they logout.
2146
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002147 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2148 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2149 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2150 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2151
2152 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2153 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2154 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2155 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2156 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2157 this attribute.
2158
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002159 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002160 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002161 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2162 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2163 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2164 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2165 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2166 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002167
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002168 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2169 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2170 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2171 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2172 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2173 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2174 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2175 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2176 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2177 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2178 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2179 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2180 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2181 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2182 the site.
2183
2184 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2185 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2186 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2187 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2188 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2189 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2190 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2191 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2192 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2193 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2194 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2195 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2196 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2197 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2198 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2199 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2200
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002201 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2202 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2203 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2204 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002205
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002206 Examples :
2207 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2208 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2209 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002210 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002211
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002212 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002213 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002214
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002215
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002216default-server [param*]
2217 Change default options for a server in a backend
2218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2219 yes | no | yes | yes
2220 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002221 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2222 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2223 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2224 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002225
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002226 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002227 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2228
2229 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002230
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002231
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002232default_backend <backend>
2233 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2234 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2235 yes | yes | yes | no
2236 Arguments :
2237 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2238
2239 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2240 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2241 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2242 will catch all undetermined requests.
2243
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002244 Example :
2245
2246 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2247 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2248 default_backend dynamic
2249
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002250 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2251
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002252
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002253description <string>
2254 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2256 no | yes | yes | yes
2257 Arguments : string
2258
2259 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2260 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2261 it describes.
2262 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2263
2264
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002265disabled
2266 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2268 yes | yes | yes | yes
2269 Arguments : none
2270
2271 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2272 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2273 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2274 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2275 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2276 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2277 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2278
2279 See also : "enabled"
2280
2281
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002282dispatch <address>:<port>
2283 Set a default server address
2284 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2285 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002286 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002287
2288 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2289 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2290 during start-up.
2291
2292 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2293 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2294 possible with normal servers.
2295
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002296 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002297 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2298 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2299 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2300 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2301
2302 See also : "server"
2303
2304
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002305enabled
2306 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2308 yes | yes | yes | yes
2309 Arguments : none
2310
2311 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2312 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2313
2314 See also : "disabled"
2315
2316
2317errorfile <code> <file>
2318 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2319 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2320 yes | yes | yes | yes
2321 Arguments :
2322 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002323 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002324
2325 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002326 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002327 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002328 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2329 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002330
2331 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2332 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2333 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2334
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002335 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2336
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002337 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2338 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2339 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2340 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2341
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002342 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2343 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2344 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2345 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2346 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2347 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2348
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002349 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2350 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2351 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002352 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002353 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2354
2355 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2356
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002357 Example :
2358 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2359 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2360 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2361
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002362
2363errorloc <code> <url>
2364errorloc302 <code> <url>
2365 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2366 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2367 yes | yes | yes | yes
2368 Arguments :
2369 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002370 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002371
2372 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2373 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2374 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2375 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2376 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2377
2378 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2379 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2380 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2381
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002382 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2383
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002384 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2385 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2386 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2387 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2388 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2389 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2390 request.
2391
2392 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2393
2394
2395errorloc303 <code> <url>
2396 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2398 yes | yes | yes | yes
2399 Arguments :
2400 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2401 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2402
2403 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2404 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2405 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2406 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2407 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2408
2409 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2410 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2411 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2412
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002413 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2414
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002415 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2416 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2417 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2418 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002419 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002420
2421 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2422
2423
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002424force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2425 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2426 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2427 no | yes | yes | yes
2428
2429 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2430 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2431 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2432 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2433 marked down for maintenance operations.
2434
2435 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2436 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2437 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2438 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2439 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2440 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2441 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2442 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2443 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2444
2445 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2446 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2447 is used.
2448
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002449 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002450 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002451
2452
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002453fullconn <conns>
2454 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2456 yes | no | yes | yes
2457 Arguments :
2458 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2459 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2460
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002461 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002462 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002463 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002464 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2465 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2466 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2467 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2468 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002469 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002470
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002471 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2472 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2473 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2474
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002475 Example :
2476 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2477 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2478 # connections.
2479 backend dynamic
2480 fullconn 10000
2481 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2482 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2483
2484 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2485
2486
2487grace <time>
2488 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002490 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002491 Arguments :
2492 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2493 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2494 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2495
2496 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2497 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002498 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002499 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2500
2501 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2502 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2503 simplify it.
2504
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002505
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002506hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002507 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2508 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2509 yes | no | yes | yes
2510 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002511 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2512 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002513
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002514 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2515 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2516 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2517 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2518 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2519 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2520 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2521 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2522 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2523 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002524
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002525 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2526 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2527 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2528 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2529 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2530 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2531 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2532 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2533 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2534 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2535 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2536 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2537 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002538 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2539 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002540
2541 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2542
2543 sdbm this function was created intially for sdbm (a public-domain
2544 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2545 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2546 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002547 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2548 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2549 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002550
2551 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2552 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002553 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2554 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2555 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2556 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2557
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002558 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2559 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2560 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2561 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2562 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2563 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2564 parameter.
2565
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002566 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2567
2568 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2569 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2570 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2571 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2572 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2573 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2574 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2575 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2576 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2577 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2578 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2579 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002580
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002581 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2582 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2583 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002584
2585 See also : "balance", "server"
2586
2587
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002588http-check disable-on-404
2589 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002591 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002592 Arguments : none
2593
2594 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2595 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2596 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2597 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2598 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2599 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2600 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2601 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002602 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2603 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2604 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2605
2606 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2607
2608
2609http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002610 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002612 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002613 Arguments :
2614 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2615 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002616 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002617 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2618 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2619 details on the supported keywords.
2620
2621 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2622 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2623 with the usual backslash ('\').
2624
2625 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2626 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2627 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2628 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2629 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2630
2631 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002632 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002633 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2634 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2635 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2636
2637 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002638 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002639 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2640 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2641 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2642 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2643
2644 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002645 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002646 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2647 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2648 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2649 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2650 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2651 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2652 trace).
2653
2654 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002655 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002656 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2657 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2658 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2659 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2660 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2661 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2662
2663 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2664 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2665 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2666 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2667 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2668 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2669 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2670 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2671
2672 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2673 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2674
2675 Examples :
2676 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002677 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002678
2679 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002680 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002681
2682 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002683 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002684
2685 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002686 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002687
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002688 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002689
2690
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002691http-check send-state
2692 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2694 yes | no | yes | yes
2695 Arguments : none
2696
2697 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2698 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2699 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2700 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2701 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2702
2703 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2704 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2705 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2706 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2707 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2708 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2709 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2710 checked in multiple backends.
2711
2712 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2713 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2714
2715 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2716 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2717 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2718 one fails.
2719
2720 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2721 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2722 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2723
2724 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2725 server's queue.
2726
2727 Example of a header received by the application server :
2728 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2729 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2730
2731 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2732
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002733http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002734 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002735 set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> | set-tos <tos> |
2736 set-mark <mark> }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002737 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002738 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2739
2740 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2741 no | yes | yes | yes
2742
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002743 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2744 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2745 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2746 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2747 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002748
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002749 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2750 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2751 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2752
2753 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2754 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2755 are evaluated.
2756
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002757 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2758 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2759 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2760 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2761 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2762 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2763 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2764 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2765 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
2766 developped robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
2767 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2768
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002769 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2770 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2771 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2772 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2773 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2774
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002775 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2776 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2777 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002778 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2779 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002780
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002781 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2782 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2783 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2784 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2785 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2786 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2787 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2788 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2789
2790 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2791 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2792 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2793 external users.
2794
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002795 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2796 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2797 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2798 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2799 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2800 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2801 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2802 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2803
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02002804 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
2805 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
2806 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
2807 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
2808 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
2809 another equipment.
2810
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02002811 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
2812 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
2813 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
2814 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
2815 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
2816 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
2817 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
2818 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
2819
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002820 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
2821 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
2822 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
2823 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
2824 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
2825 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
2826 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
2827 admin privileges.
2828
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002829 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
2830
2831 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
2832 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
2833 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
2834 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002835
2836 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002837 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2838 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2839 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002840
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002841 http-request allow if nagios
2842 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2843 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2844 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002845
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002846 Example:
2847 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002848 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002849
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002850 Example:
2851 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
2852 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
2853 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
2854 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
2855 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
2856 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
2857 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
2858 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
2859 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
2860
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002861 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2862 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002863
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002864http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002865 set-header <name> <fmt> | set-log-level <level> |
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02002866 set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> }
2867 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002868 Access control for Layer 7 responses
2869
2870 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2871 no | yes | yes | yes
2872
2873 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2874 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2875 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2876 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2877 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
2878 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
2879
2880 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2881 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
2882 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
2883 current section.
2884
2885 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2886 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
2887 rules are evaluated.
2888
2889 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2890 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2891 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
2892 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
2893 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
2894 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
2895 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
2896
2897 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2898 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2899 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2900 external users.
2901
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002902 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2903 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2904 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2905 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2906 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2907 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2908 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2909 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2910
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02002911 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
2912 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
2913 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
2914 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
2915 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
2916 another equipment.
2917
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02002918 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
2919 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
2920 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
2921 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
2922 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
2923 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
2924 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
2925 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
2926
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002927 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
2928 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
2929 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
2930 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
2931 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
2932 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
2933 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
2934 admin privileges.
2935
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002936 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
2937
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08002938 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002939 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
2940 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
2941 rules.
2942
2943 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
2944 ACL usage.
2945
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02002946
2947tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
2948 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
2949 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2950 no | no | yes | yes
2951
2952 Arguments :
2953 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2954 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
2955 binary.
2956 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
2957 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
2958 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
2959
2960 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2961 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2962 with the usual backslash ('\').
2963 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
2964 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
2965 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
2966 used upper or lower case.
2967
2968
2969 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
2970
2971 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
2972 A health check response will be considered valid if the
2973 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
2974 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2975 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2976 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
2977 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
2978 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
2979
2980 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
2981 A health check response will be considered valid if the
2982 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
2983 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2984 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
2985 expression.
2986
2987 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
2988 in the response buffer. A health check response will
2989 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
2990 this exact hexadecimal string.
2991 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
2992
2993 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2994 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2995 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2996 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
2997 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2998 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2999 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3000 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
3001 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
3002 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
3003 the null character.
3004
3005 Examples :
3006 # perform a POP check
3007 option tcp-check
3008 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
3009
3010 # perform an IMAP check
3011 option tcp-check
3012 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
3013
3014 # look for the redis master server
3015 option tcp-check
3016 tcp-check send PING\r\n
3017 tcp-check expect +PONG
3018 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
3019 tcp-check expect string role:master
3020 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
3021 tcp-check expect string +OK
3022
3023
3024 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "http-check expect",
3025 tune.chksize
3026
3027
3028tcp-check send <data>
3029 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
3030 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3031 no | no | yes | yes
3032
3033 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
3034 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
3035
3036 Examples :
3037 # look for the redis master server
3038 option tcp-check
3039 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
3040 tcp-check expect string role:master
3041
3042 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send-binary",
3043 tune.chksize
3044
3045
3046tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
3047 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
3048 tcp health check
3049 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3050 no | no | yes | yes
3051
3052 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
3053 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
3054 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
3055 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
3056 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
3057 hexadecimal string.
3058 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
3059
3060 Examples :
3061 # redis check in binary
3062 option tcp-check
3063 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
3064 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
3065
3066
3067 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send",
3068 tune.chksize
3069
3070
3071
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003072http-send-name-header [<header>]
3073 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3074
3075 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3076 yes | no | yes | yes
3077
3078 Arguments :
3079
3080 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3081
3082 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3083 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3084 is added with the header string proved.
3085
3086 See also : "server"
3087
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003088id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003089 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3091 no | yes | yes | yes
3092 Arguments : none
3093
3094 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3095 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3096 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003097
3098
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003099ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3100 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3101 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3102 no | yes | yes | yes
3103
3104 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3105 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3106 and running).
3107
3108 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3109 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3110 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
3111 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
3112 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3113
3114 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3115 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3116
3117 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3118 "unless" condition is met.
3119
3120 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3121
3122
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003123log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003124log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003125no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003126 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3127 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3128 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003129
3130 Prefix :
3131 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3132 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3133 prefix does not allow arguments.
3134
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003135 Arguments :
3136 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3137 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3138 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3139 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3140 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3141 parameter.
3142
3143 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3144 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3145
3146 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3147 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3148 standard syslog port).
3149
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003150 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3151 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3152 standard syslog port).
3153
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003154 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3155 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3156 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3157 appropriately writeable).
3158
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003159 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3160 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3161 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3162 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3163
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003164 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3165
3166 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3167 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3168 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3169
3170 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3171 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3172 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003173 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3174 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3175 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3176 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3177 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003178
3179 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3180
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003181 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3182 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3183 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003184
3185 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3186 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3187 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3188 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3189
3190 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3191 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003192
3193 Example :
3194 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003195 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3196 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003197 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3198
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003199
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003200log-format <string>
3201 Allows you to custom a log line.
3202
3203 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
3204
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003205
3206maxconn <conns>
3207 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3208 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3209 yes | yes | yes | no
3210 Arguments :
3211 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3212 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3213 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3214 closes.
3215
3216 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3217 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3218 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3219 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3220 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3221 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3222 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3223 properly tuned.
3224
3225 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3226 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3227 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3228
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003229 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3230
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003231 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3232
3233
3234mode { tcp|http|health }
3235 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3237 yes | yes | yes | yes
3238 Arguments :
3239 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3240 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3241 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3242 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3243
3244 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3245 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3246 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3247 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3248 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3249
3250 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003251 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3252 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3253 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3254 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3255 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3256 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3257 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003258
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003259 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3260 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3261 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003262
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003263 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003264 defaults http_instances
3265 mode http
3266
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003267 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003268
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003269
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003270monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003271 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003272 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3273 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003274 Arguments :
3275 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3276 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003277 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003278 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3279 backend and its backup.
3280
3281 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3282 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3283 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3284 servers in a list of backends.
3285
3286 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3287 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3288 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3289 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3290 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3291 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3292 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003293 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3294 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003295
3296 Example:
3297 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003298 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003299 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3300 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3301 monitor-uri /site_alive
3302 monitor fail if site_dead
3303
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003304 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003305
3306
3307monitor-net <source>
3308 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3310 yes | yes | yes | no
3311 Arguments :
3312 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3313 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3314 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3315 followed by a mask.
3316
3317 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3318 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003319 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003320 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3321
3322 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3323 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3324 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3325 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003326 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3327 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3328 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003329
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003330 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3331 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3332 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3333 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3334 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3335 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003336
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003337 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3338 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003339
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003340 Example :
3341 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3342 frontend www
3343 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3344
3345 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3346
3347
3348monitor-uri <uri>
3349 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3350 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3351 yes | yes | yes | no
3352 Arguments :
3353 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3354 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3355
3356 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3357 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3358 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3359 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3360 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3361 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3362 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3363 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3364
3365 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3366 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3367 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3368 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3369 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3370 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3371
3372 Example :
3373 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3374 frontend www
3375 mode http
3376 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3377
3378 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3379
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003380
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003381option abortonclose
3382no option abortonclose
3383 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3385 yes | no | yes | yes
3386 Arguments : none
3387
3388 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3389 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3390 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3391 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003392 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003393 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3394 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3395 encountered while delivering the response.
3396
3397 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3398 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3399 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3400 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3401 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3402 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003403 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003404 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003405 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003406 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3407 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3408 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3409
3410 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3411 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3412 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3413 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3414 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3415 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3416 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3417 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003418 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003419
3420 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3421 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3422
3423 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3424
3425
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003426option accept-invalid-http-request
3427no option accept-invalid-http-request
3428 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3430 yes | yes | yes | no
3431 Arguments : none
3432
3433 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3434 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3435 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3436 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3437 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3438 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3439 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3440 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003441 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3442 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3443 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3444 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3445 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3446 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003447
3448 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3449 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3450 been confirmed.
3451
3452 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3453 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003454 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3455 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003456 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3457
3458 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3459 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3460
3461 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3462 stats socket.
3463
3464
3465option accept-invalid-http-response
3466no option accept-invalid-http-response
3467 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3469 yes | no | yes | yes
3470 Arguments : none
3471
3472 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3473 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3474 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3475 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3476 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3477 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3478 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3479 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3480 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3481
3482 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3483 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3484 been confirmed.
3485
3486 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3487 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3488 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3489 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3490
3491 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3492 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3493
3494 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3495 stats socket.
3496
3497
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003498option allbackups
3499no option allbackups
3500 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3502 yes | no | yes | yes
3503 Arguments : none
3504
3505 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3506 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3507 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3508 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3509 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3510 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3511 order between the backup servers anymore.
3512
3513 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3514 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3515
3516 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3517 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3518
3519
3520option checkcache
3521no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003522 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3524 yes | no | yes | yes
3525 Arguments : none
3526
3527 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3528 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003529 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003530 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3531 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003532 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003533
3534 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003535 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003536 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003537 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3538 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003539 to the client are :
3540 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003541 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003542 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003543 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3544 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3545 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3546 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3547 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3548 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3549 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3550 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3551 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3552 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3553 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3554
3555 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003556 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003557 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003558 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003559 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3560
3561 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3562 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003563 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003564 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3565
3566 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3567 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3568
3569
3570option clitcpka
3571no option clitcpka
3572 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3573 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3574 yes | yes | yes | no
3575 Arguments : none
3576
3577 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3578 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3579 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3580 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3581
3582 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3583 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3584 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3585 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3586
3587 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3588 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3589 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3590 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3591 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3592
3593 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3594
3595 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3596 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3597 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3598
3599 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3600 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3601
3602 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3603
3604
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003605option contstats
3606 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3608 yes | yes | yes | no
3609 Arguments : none
3610
3611 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3612 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3613 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3614 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3615 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3616 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3617 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3618
3619
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003620option dontlog-normal
3621no option dontlog-normal
3622 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3624 yes | yes | yes | no
3625 Arguments : none
3626
3627 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3628 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3629 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3630 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3631 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3632 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3633 logged.
3634
3635 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3636 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3637 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3638
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003639 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003640 logging.
3641
3642
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003643option dontlognull
3644no option dontlognull
3645 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3647 yes | yes | yes | no
3648 Arguments : none
3649
3650 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3651 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3652 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3653 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3654 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3655 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3656 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3657
3658 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3659 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3660 would not be logged.
3661
3662 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3663 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3664
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003665 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003666
3667
3668option forceclose
3669no option forceclose
3670 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003672 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003673 Arguments : none
3674
3675 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3676 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3677 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3678 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3679 global session times in the logs.
3680
3681 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003682 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003683 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3684 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3685 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3686 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003687
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003688 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3689 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3690 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3691
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003692 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3693 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3694
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003695 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003696
3697
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003698option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003699 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3701 yes | yes | yes | yes
3702 Arguments :
3703 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3704 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003705 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003706 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003707
3708 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3709 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3710 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3711 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3712 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3713 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3714 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003715 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3716 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3717 possible that the client has already brought one.
3718
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003719 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003720 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003721 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3722 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003723 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3724 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003725
3726 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3727 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3728 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3729 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3730 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3731 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3732 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3733
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003734 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3735 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3736 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3737 are under the control of the end-user.
3738
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003739 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003740 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3741 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003742 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3743 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3744 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003745
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003746 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3747 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3748 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3749 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3750 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003751
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003752 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003753 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3754 frontend www
3755 mode http
3756 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3757
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003758 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3759 backend www
3760 mode http
3761 option forwardfor header X-Client
3762
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003763 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3764 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003765
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003766
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003767option http-keep-alive
3768no option http-keep-alive
3769 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
3770 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3771 yes | yes | yes | yes
3772 Arguments : none
3773
3774 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3775 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3776 "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client- and
3777 server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3778 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
3779 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
3780 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
3781 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
3782 situations where this option may be useful :
3783
3784 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
3785 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
3786
3787 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
3788 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
3789
3790 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
3791 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
3792 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
3793 request.
3794
3795 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
3796 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01003797 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
3798 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
3799 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003800
3801 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
3802 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
3803
3804 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3805 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3806 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3807 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
3808 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3809 not set.
3810
3811 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3812 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3813 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3814 have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
3815
3816 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3817 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3818
3819 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01003820 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3821 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003822
3823
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003824option http-no-delay
3825no option http-no-delay
3826 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3828 yes | yes | yes | yes
3829 Arguments : none
3830
3831 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3832 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3833 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3834 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3835 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3836 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3837 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3838 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3839 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3840 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3841 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3842 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3843 affected.
3844
3845 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3846 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3847 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3848 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3849 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3850 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3851 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3852 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3853 latency environments.
3854
3855
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003856option http-pretend-keepalive
3857no option http-pretend-keepalive
3858 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3860 yes | yes | yes | yes
3861 Arguments : none
3862
3863 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3864 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3865 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3866 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3867 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3868 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3869 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3870 consider the response complete.
3871
3872 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3873 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3874 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3875 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3876 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3877 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3878
3879 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3880 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3881 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3882 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3883 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3884 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3885 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3886
3887 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3888 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003889 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003890 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3891 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003892
3893 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3894 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3895
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003896 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
3897 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003898
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003899
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003900option http-server-close
3901no option http-server-close
3902 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3904 yes | yes | yes | yes
3905 Arguments : none
3906
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003907 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3908 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3909 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3910 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3911 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3912 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3913 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3914 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3915 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3916 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3917 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3918 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003919
3920 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3921 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3922 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3923 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003924 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3925 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003926
3927 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3928 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003929 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3930 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3931 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003932
3933 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3934 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3935
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003936 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003937 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
3938 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003939
3940
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003941option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003942no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003943 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3944 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3945 yes | yes | yes | no
3946 Arguments : none
3947
3948 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3949 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3950 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3951 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3952 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3953 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3954 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3955
3956 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3957 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3958 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3959 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3960 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3961 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3962 request along its whole life.
3963
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003964 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3965 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3966 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3967 front of an existing proxy.
3968
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003969 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3970
3971 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3972 http-server-close".
3973
3974
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003975option httpchk
3976option httpchk <uri>
3977option httpchk <method> <uri>
3978option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3979 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3980 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3981 yes | no | yes | yes
3982 Arguments :
3983 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3984 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3985 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3986 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3987 ones.
3988
3989 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3990 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3991 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3992
3993 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3994 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3995 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3996 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3997 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3998
3999 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4000 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4001 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4002 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4003 the lack of any response.
4004
4005 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4006
4007 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4008 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4009 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4010
4011 Examples :
4012 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4013 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4014 backend https_relay
4015 mode tcp
4016 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4017 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4018
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004019 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4020 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4021 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004022
4023
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004024option httpclose
4025no option httpclose
4026 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4028 yes | yes | yes | yes
4029 Arguments : none
4030
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004031 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
4032 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
4033 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
4034 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
4035 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
4036 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
4037 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004038
4039 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004040 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004041 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4042 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4043 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4044 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4045 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004046
4047 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4048 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
4049 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004050 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
4051 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004052
4053 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4054 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4055
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004056 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4057 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004058
4059
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004060option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004061 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4063 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004064 Arguments :
4065 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4066 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4067 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4068 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4069 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004070
4071 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4072 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4073 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4074 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4075 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4076 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4077 ports.
4078
4079 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4080
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004081 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4082 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
4083 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
4084 by default.
4085
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004086 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004087
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004088
4089option http_proxy
4090no option http_proxy
4091 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4093 yes | yes | yes | yes
4094 Arguments : none
4095
4096 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4097 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4098 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4099 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4100 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4101
4102 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4103 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4104 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4105 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004106 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004107 be analyzed.
4108
4109 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4110 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4111
4112 Example :
4113 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4114 backend direct_forward
4115 option httpclose
4116 option http_proxy
4117
4118 See also : "option httpclose"
4119
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004120
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004121option independent-streams
4122no option independent-streams
4123 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4125 yes | yes | yes | yes
4126 Arguments : none
4127
4128 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4129 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4130 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4131 receive data or not.
4132
4133 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4134 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4135 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4136 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4137 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4138 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4139 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4140 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4141 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4142 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4143 socket buffers.
4144
4145 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4146 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4147 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4148 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4149 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4150
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004151 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
4152 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4153 deprecated.
4154
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004155 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004156
4157
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004158option ldap-check
4159 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4161 yes | no | yes | yes
4162 Arguments : none
4163
4164 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4165 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4166 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4167 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4168
4169 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4170 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4171
4172 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4173 configure it.
4174
4175 Example :
4176 option ldap-check
4177
4178 See also : "option httpchk"
4179
4180
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004181option log-health-checks
4182no option log-health-checks
4183 Enable or disable logging of health checks
4184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4185 yes | no | yes | yes
4186 Arguments : none
4187
4188 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
4189 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
4190 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
4191 of additional information is limited.
4192
4193 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
4194 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
4195
4196 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
4197
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004198
4199option log-separate-errors
4200no option log-separate-errors
4201 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4202 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4203 yes | yes | yes | no
4204 Arguments : none
4205
4206 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4207 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4208 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4209 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4210 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4211 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4212 provides very important information.
4213
4214 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4215 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4216 error logs.
4217
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004218 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004219 logging.
4220
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004221
4222option logasap
4223no option logasap
4224 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4226 yes | yes | yes | no
4227 Arguments : none
4228
4229 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4230 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4231 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4232 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4233 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4234 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4235 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004236 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004237 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4238 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4239
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004240 Examples :
4241 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4242 mode http
4243 option httplog
4244 option logasap
4245 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4246
4247 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4248 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4249 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4250 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004252 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004253 logging.
4254
4255
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004256option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
4257 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4259 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004260 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004261 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4262 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004263
4264 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4265 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4266 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4267 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4268 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4269 in the MySQL table, like this :
4270
4271 USE mysql;
4272 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4273 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4274
4275 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4276 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4277 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4278 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4279 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4280 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4281 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4282 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4283 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4284
4285 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4286 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004287
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004288 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004289
4290 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4291 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4292 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4293 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4294 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4295 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4296
4297 See also: "option httpchk"
4298
4299
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004300option nolinger
4301no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004302 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004303 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4304 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004305 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004306
4307 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4308 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4309 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4310 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4311 connections.
4312
4313 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4314 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4315 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4316 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4317 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4318 this too.
4319
4320 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4321 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4322 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4323
4324 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4325 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4326 for servers.
4327
4328 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4329 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4330
4331
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004332option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4333 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4335 yes | yes | yes | yes
4336 Arguments :
4337 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4338 matching <network>
4339 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4340 header name.
4341
4342 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4343 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4344 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4345 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4346 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4347 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4348 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4349 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4350 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4351 possible that the client has already brought one.
4352
4353 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4354 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4355 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4356 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4357 header and requires different one.
4358
4359 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4360 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4361 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4362 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4363 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4364 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4365 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4366
4367 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4368 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4369 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4370 both are defined.
4371
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004372 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
4373 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
4374 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
4375 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
4376 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004377
4378 Examples :
4379 # Original Destination address
4380 frontend www
4381 mode http
4382 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4383
4384 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4385 backend www
4386 mode http
4387 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4388
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004389 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4390 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004391
4392
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004393option persist
4394no option persist
4395 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4396 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4397 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004398 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004399
4400 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4401 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4402 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4403 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4404 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4405 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4406 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4407 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4408 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4409 redirected to another valid server.
4410
4411 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4412 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4413
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004414 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004415
4416
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004417option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4418 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4419 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4420 yes | no | yes | yes
4421 Arguments :
4422 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4423 PostgreSQL server.
4424
4425 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4426 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4427 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4428 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4429
4430 See also: "option httpchk"
4431
4432
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004433option prefer-last-server
4434no option prefer-last-server
4435 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4436 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4437 yes | no | yes | yes
4438 Arguments : none
4439
4440 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4441 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4442 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4443 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4444 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4445 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4446 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4447 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4448 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004449 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4450 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4451 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4452 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4453 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4454 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4455 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004456
4457 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4458 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4459
4460 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4461
4462
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004463option redispatch
4464no option redispatch
4465 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4466 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4467 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004468 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004469
4470 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4471 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4472 be able to access the service anymore.
4473
4474 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4475 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4476
4477 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4478 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4479 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004480
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004481 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4482 "redisp" keywords.
4483
4484 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4485 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4486
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004487 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004488
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004489
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004490option redis-check
4491 Use redis health checks for server testing
4492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4493 yes | no | yes | yes
4494 Arguments : none
4495
4496 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4497 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4498 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4499 find the "+PONG" response message.
4500
4501 Example :
4502 option redis-check
4503
4504 See also : "option httpchk"
4505
4506
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004507option smtpchk
4508option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4509 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4511 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004512 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004513 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4514 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4515 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4516
4517 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4518 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4519 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4520
4521 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4522 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4523 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4524 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4525 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4526 dead server.
4527
4528 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4529 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4530 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4531 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4532
4533 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4534 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4535 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4536 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4537 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4538
4539 Example :
4540 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4541
4542 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4543
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004544
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004545option socket-stats
4546no option socket-stats
4547
4548 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4550 yes | yes | yes | no
4551
4552 Arguments : none
4553
4554
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004555option splice-auto
4556no option splice-auto
4557 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4559 yes | yes | yes | yes
4560 Arguments : none
4561
4562 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4563 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4564 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4565 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004566 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004567 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4568 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4569 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4570 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4571
4572 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4573 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4574 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4575 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4576 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4577 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4578 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4579 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4580 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4581 keyword.
4582
4583 Example :
4584 option splice-auto
4585
4586 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4587 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4588
4589 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4590 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4591
4592
4593option splice-request
4594no option splice-request
4595 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4597 yes | yes | yes | yes
4598 Arguments : none
4599
4600 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004601 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004602 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4603 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4604 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4605 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4606
4607 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4608
4609 Example :
4610 option splice-request
4611
4612 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4613 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4614
4615 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4616 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4617
4618
4619option splice-response
4620no option splice-response
4621 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4623 yes | yes | yes | yes
4624 Arguments : none
4625
4626 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004627 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004628 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4629 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4630 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4631 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4632
4633 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4634
4635 Example :
4636 option splice-response
4637
4638 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4639 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4640
4641 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4642 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4643
4644
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004645option srvtcpka
4646no option srvtcpka
4647 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4649 yes | no | yes | yes
4650 Arguments : none
4651
4652 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4653 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4654 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4655 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4656
4657 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4658 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4659 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4660 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4661
4662 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4663 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4664 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4665 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4666 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4667
4668 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4669
4670 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4671 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4672 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4673
4674 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4675 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4676
4677 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4678
4679
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004680option ssl-hello-chk
4681 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4683 yes | no | yes | yes
4684 Arguments : none
4685
4686 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4687 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4688 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4689 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4690 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4691 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4692 hello message.
4693
4694 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4695 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4696 messages, which is appreciable.
4697
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004698 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4699 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4700 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004701
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004702 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4703
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004704
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004705option tcp-check
4706 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
4707 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4708 yes | no | yes | yes
4709
4710 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
4711 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
4712
4713 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
4714 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
4715 attempt, which remains the default mode.
4716
4717 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentionned : this is
4718 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
4719 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
4720 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
4721 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
4722 only.
4723
4724 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentionned : this is used to test a banner.
4725 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
4726 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
4727 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
4728 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
4729
4730 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentionned : this is
4731 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
4732 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
4733 the maching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
4734 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
4735 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
4736 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
4737 the respective protocols.
4738 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
4739 analysed.
4740
4741 Examples :
4742 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
4743 option tcp-check
4744 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
4745
4746 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
4747 option tcp-check
4748 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
4749
4750 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
4751 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
4752 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 tims)
4753 option tcp-check
4754 tcp-check send PING\r\n
4755 tcp-check expect +PONG
4756 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
4757 tcp-check expect string role:master
4758 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
4759 tcp-check expect string +OK
4760
4761 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
4762 (send many headers before analyzing)
4763 option tcp-check
4764 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
4765 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
4766 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
4767 tcp-check send \r\n
4768 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
4769
4770
4771 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
4772
4773
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004774option tcp-smart-accept
4775no option tcp-smart-accept
4776 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4778 yes | yes | yes | no
4779 Arguments : none
4780
4781 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4782 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4783 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4784 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4785 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4786 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4787
4788 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4789 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4790 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4791 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4792
4793 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4794 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4795 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4796 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4797
4798 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4799 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4800 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4801
4802 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4803 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4804 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4805
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004806 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4807
4808
4809option tcp-smart-connect
4810no option tcp-smart-connect
4811 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4813 yes | no | yes | yes
4814 Arguments : none
4815
4816 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4817 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4818 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4819 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4820 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4821
4822 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4823 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4824 complex.
4825
4826 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4827 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4828 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4829
4830 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4831 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4832
4833 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4834
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004835
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004836option tcpka
4837 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4839 yes | yes | yes | yes
4840 Arguments : none
4841
4842 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4843 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4844 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4845 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4846
4847 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4848 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4849 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4850 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4851
4852 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4853 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4854 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4855 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4856 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4857
4858 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4859
4860 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4861 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4862 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4863 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4864 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4865 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4866 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4867 backends.
4868
4869 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4870
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004871
4872option tcplog
4873 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4875 yes | yes | yes | yes
4876 Arguments : none
4877
4878 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4879 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4880 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4881 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4882 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4883 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4884 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4885 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4886
4887 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4888
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004889 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004890
4891
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004892option transparent
4893no option transparent
4894 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004896 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004897 Arguments : none
4898
4899 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4900 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4901 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4902 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4903 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4904 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4905 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4906 appropriate server.
4907
4908 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4909 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4910
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004911 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004912 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004913
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004914
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004915persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004916persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004917 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4918 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4919 yes | no | yes | yes
4920 Arguments :
4921 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004922 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4923 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004924
4925 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4926 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4927 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4928 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4929 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4930 forwarded to this server.
4931
4932 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4933 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4934 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004935 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004936 a single "listen" section.
4937
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004938 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4939 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4940 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4941
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004942 Example :
4943 listen tse-farm
4944 bind :3389
4945 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4946 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4947 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4948 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4949 persist rdp-cookie
4950 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004951 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004952 balance rdp-cookie
4953 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4954 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4955
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004956 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4957 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004958
4959
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004960rate-limit sessions <rate>
4961 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4963 yes | yes | yes | no
4964 Arguments :
4965 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4966 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4967
4968 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4969 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4970 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4971 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4972 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4973 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4974
4975 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4976 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4977 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4978 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4979
4980 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4981 listen smtp
4982 mode tcp
4983 bind :25
4984 rate-limit sessions 10
4985 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4986
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004987 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4988 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4989 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004990
4991 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4992
4993
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004994redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4995redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4996redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004997 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4998 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4999 no | yes | yes | yes
5000
5001 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005002 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005003
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005004 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005005 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005006 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5007 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5008 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005009
5010 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5011 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5012 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5013 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5014 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005015 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5016 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5017 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5018 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005019
5020 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5021 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5022 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5023 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5024 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5025 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
5026 returned, which most recent browsers interprete as redirecting to
5027 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005028 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5029 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5030 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005031
5032 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005033 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5034 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5035 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5036 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5037 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5038 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5039 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5040 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005041
5042 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5043 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5044
5045 - "drop-query"
5046 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5047 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5048 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5049 with a location-type redirect.
5050
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005051 - "append-slash"
5052 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5053 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5054 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5055 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5056
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005057 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5058 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5059 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5060 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5061 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5062 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5063 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5064
5065 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5066 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5067 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5068 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5069 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5070 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5071 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005072
5073 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5074 acl clear dst_port 80
5075 acl secure dst_port 8080
5076 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005077 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005078 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005079 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5080
5081 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005082 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5083 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5084 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005085 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005086
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005087 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5088 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5089 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5090
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005091 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005092 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005093
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005094 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5095 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5096 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5097
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005098 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005099
5100
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005101redisp (deprecated)
5102redispatch (deprecated)
5103 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5104 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5105 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005106 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005107
5108 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5109 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5110 be able to access the service anymore.
5111
5112 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5113 redistribute them to a working server.
5114
5115 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5116 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5117 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005118
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005119 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5120 "option redispatch" instead.
5121
5122 See also : "option redispatch"
5123
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005124
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005125reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005126 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5127 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5128 no | yes | yes | yes
5129 Arguments :
5130 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5131 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005132 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005133
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005134 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5135 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5136
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005137 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5138 the last header of an HTTP request.
5139
5140 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5141 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5142 responses.
5143
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005144 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5145 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5146 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5147
5148 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5149 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005150
5151
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005152reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5153reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005154 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5155 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5156 no | yes | yes | yes
5157 Arguments :
5158 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5159 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5160 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5161 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5162 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5163 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5164 ignores case.
5165
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005166 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5167 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5168
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005169 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5170 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5171 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5172 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005173 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005174
5175 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5176 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5177
5178 Example :
5179 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5180 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5181 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5182
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005183 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5184 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005185
5186
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005187reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5188reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005189 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5191 no | yes | yes | yes
5192 Arguments :
5193 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5194 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5195 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5196 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5197 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5198 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5199
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005200 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5201 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5202
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005203 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5204 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5205 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5206 next servers.
5207
5208 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5209 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5210 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5211
5212 Example :
5213 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5214 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5215 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5216
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005217 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5218 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005219
5220
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005221reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5222reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005223 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5225 no | yes | yes | yes
5226 Arguments :
5227 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5228 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5229 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5230 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5231 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5232 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5233 case.
5234
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005235 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5236 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5237
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005238 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5239 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5240 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5241 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005242 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005243
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005244 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005245 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005246 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005247
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005248 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5249 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5250
5251 Example :
5252 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5253 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5254 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5255
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005256 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5257 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005258
5259
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005260reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5261reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005262 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5263 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5264 no | yes | yes | yes
5265 Arguments :
5266 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5267 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5268 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5269 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5270 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5271 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5272 case.
5273
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005274 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5275 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5276
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005277 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5278 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5279 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5280 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5281
5282 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5283 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5284
5285 Example :
5286 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5287 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5288 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5289 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5290
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005291 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5292 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005293
5294
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005295reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5296reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005297 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5299 no | yes | yes | yes
5300 Arguments :
5301 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5302 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5303 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5304 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5305 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5306 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5307
5308 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5309 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5310 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5311 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005312 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005313
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005314 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5315 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5316
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005317 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5318 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5319 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5320
5321 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5322 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5323 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5324 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5325 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5326
5327 Example :
5328 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005329 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005330 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5331 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5332
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005333 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5334 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005335
5336
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005337reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5338reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005339 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5340 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5341 no | yes | yes | yes
5342 Arguments :
5343 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5344 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5345 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5346 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5347 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5348 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5349 ignores case.
5350
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005351 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5352 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5353
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005354 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5355 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005356 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5357 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5358 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005359 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5360 not set.
5361
5362 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5363 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5364 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5365 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5366 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5367
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005368 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005369 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5370 # block all others.
5371 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5372 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5373
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005374 # block bad guys
5375 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5376 reqitarpit . if badguys
5377
5378 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5379 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005380
5381
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005382retries <value>
5383 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5384 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5385 yes | no | yes | yes
5386 Arguments :
5387 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5388 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5389 default value is 3.
5390
5391 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5392 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5393 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5394
5395 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5396 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5397
5398 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5399 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5400
5401 See also : "option redispatch"
5402
5403
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005404rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005405 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5407 no | yes | yes | yes
5408 Arguments :
5409 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5410 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005411 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005412
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005413 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5414 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5415
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005416 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5417 the last header of an HTTP response.
5418
5419 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5420 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5421 responses.
5422
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005423 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5424 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005425
5426
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005427rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5428rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005429 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5430 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5431 no | yes | yes | yes
5432 Arguments :
5433 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5434 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5435 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5436 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5437 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5438 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5439 ignores case.
5440
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005441 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5442 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5443
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005444 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5445 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005446 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005447 client.
5448
5449 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5450 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5451 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5452
5453 Example :
5454 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005455 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005456
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005457 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5458 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005459
5460
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005461rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5462rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005463 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5465 no | yes | yes | yes
5466 Arguments :
5467 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5468 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5469 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5470 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5471 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5472 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5473 ignores case.
5474
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005475 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5476 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5477
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005478 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5479 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5480 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5481 case-sensitive.
5482
5483 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005484 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5485 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5486 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005487
5488 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5489 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5490
5491 Example :
5492 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5493 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5494
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005495 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5496 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005497
5498
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005499rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5500rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005501 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5502 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5503 no | yes | yes | yes
5504 Arguments :
5505 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5506 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5507 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5508 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5509 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5510 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5511 ignores case.
5512
5513 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5514 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5515 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5516 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005517 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005518
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005519 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5520 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5521
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005522 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5523 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5524 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5525
5526 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5527 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5528 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5529 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5530 are not case-sensitive.
5531
5532 Example :
5533 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5534 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5535
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005536 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5537 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005538
5539
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005540server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005541 Declare a server in a backend
5542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5543 no | no | yes | yes
5544 Arguments :
5545 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005546 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005547 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005548
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005549 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5550 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5551 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5552 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005553 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5554 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5555 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5556 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5557 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005558 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5559 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5560 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5561 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5562 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5563 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5564 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005565 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5566 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5567 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5568 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005569
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005570 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005571 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5572 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5573 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5574 adding this value to the client's port.
5575
5576 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5577 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005578 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005579
5580 Examples :
5581 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5582 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005583 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005584 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5585 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5586 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005587
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005588 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5589 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005590
5591
5592source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005593source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005594source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005595 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5597 yes | no | yes | yes
5598 Arguments :
5599 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5600 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005601
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005602 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005603 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
5604 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
5605 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
5606 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
5607 supported prefixes are :
5608 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5609 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5610 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005611 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5612 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5613 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5614 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005615
5616 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5617 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005618 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5619 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5620 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005621
5622 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5623 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5624 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5625 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
5626 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
5627 <addr>.
5628
5629 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
5630 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
5631 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
5632 port.
5633
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005634 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
5635 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
5636 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5637 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01005638 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005639 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
5640 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
5641 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
5642 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
5643 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
5644 HTTP header.
5645
5646 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
5647 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005648 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005649 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
5650 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
5651 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
5652 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
5653 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
5654 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
5655 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
5656
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005657 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
5658 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
5659 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
5660 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
5661 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
5662 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
5663
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005664 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
5665 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
5666 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
5667 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
5668
5669 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
5670 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
5671 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
5672 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
5673 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
5674 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
5675
5676 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
5677 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
5678 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
5679 there are two methods :
5680
5681 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
5682 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
5683 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
5684 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
5685 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
5686 of the client ranges may be used.
5687
5688 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
5689 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
5690 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
5691 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
5692 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
5693 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
5694 same session.
5695
5696 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
5697 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
5698 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
5699 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
5700 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
5701 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
5702
5703 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
5704 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
5705 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005706 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005707
5708 Examples :
5709 backend private
5710 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
5711 source 192.168.1.200
5712
5713 backend transparent_ssl1
5714 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
5715 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5716
5717 backend transparent_ssl2
5718 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
5719 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
5720 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
5721
5722 backend transparent_ssl3
5723 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5724 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5725 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5726
5727 backend transparent_smtp
5728 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5729 # with Tproxy version 4.
5730 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5731
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005732 backend transparent_http
5733 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5734 # proxy.
5735 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5736
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005737 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005738 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5739
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005740
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005741srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5742 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5743 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5744 yes | no | yes | yes
5745 Arguments :
5746 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5747 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5748 as explained at the top of this document.
5749
5750 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5751 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5752 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5753 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5754 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5755 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5756 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5757
5758 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5759 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5760 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5761 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5762 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005763 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005764 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005765 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005766
5767 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5768 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5769 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5770 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5771 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5772 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5773
5774 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5775 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5776
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005777 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5778 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005779
5780
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005781stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5782 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5784 no | no | yes | yes
5785
5786 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5787 matched.
5788
5789 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5790 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5791
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005792 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5793 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5794 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5795
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005796 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5797 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5798 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5799 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005800
5801 Example :
5802 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5803 backend stats_localhost
5804 stats enable
5805 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5806
5807 Example :
5808 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5809 backend stats_auth
5810 stats enable
5811 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5812 stats admin if TRUE
5813
5814 Example :
5815 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5816 userlist stats-auth
5817 group admin users admin
5818 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5819 group readonly users haproxy
5820 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5821
5822 backend stats_auth
5823 stats enable
5824 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5825 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5826 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5827 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5828
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005829 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5830 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5831 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005832
5833
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005834stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5835 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5837 yes | no | yes | yes
5838 Arguments :
5839 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5840
5841 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5842
5843 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5844 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5845 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5846 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5847 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5848 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5849
5850 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5851 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5852 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005853 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005854
5855 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5856 report using "stats scope".
5857
5858 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5859 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5860 unobvious parameters.
5861
5862 Example :
5863 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5864 backend public_www
5865 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5866 stats enable
5867 stats hide-version
5868 stats scope .
5869 stats uri /admin?stats
5870 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5871 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5872 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5873
5874 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5875 backend private_monitoring
5876 stats enable
5877 stats uri /admin?stats
5878 stats refresh 5s
5879
5880 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5881
5882
5883stats enable
5884 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5886 yes | no | yes | yes
5887 Arguments : none
5888
5889 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5890 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5891 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5892 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5893 - stats auth : no authentication
5894 - stats scope : no restriction
5895
5896 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5897 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5898 unobvious parameters.
5899
5900 Example :
5901 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5902 backend public_www
5903 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5904 stats enable
5905 stats hide-version
5906 stats scope .
5907 stats uri /admin?stats
5908 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5909 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5910 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5911
5912 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5913 backend private_monitoring
5914 stats enable
5915 stats uri /admin?stats
5916 stats refresh 5s
5917
5918 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5919
5920
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005921stats hide-version
5922 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005923 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5924 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005925 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005926
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005927 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5928 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5929 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5930 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5931 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5932 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005933
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005934 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5935 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5936 unobvious parameters.
5937
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005938 Example :
5939 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5940 backend public_www
5941 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005942 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005943 stats hide-version
5944 stats scope .
5945 stats uri /admin?stats
5946 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5947 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5948 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005949
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005950 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5951 backend private_monitoring
5952 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005953 stats uri /admin?stats
5954 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005955
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005956 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005957
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005958
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005959stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5960 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5961 Access control for statistics
5962
5963 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5964 no | no | yes | yes
5965
5966 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5967 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5968 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5969 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5970 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5971 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5972
5973 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5974 instance.
5975
5976 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5977 about ACL usage.
5978
5979
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005980stats realm <realm>
5981 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5983 yes | no | yes | yes
5984 Arguments :
5985 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5986 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5987 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5988
5989 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5990 using a backslash ('\').
5991
5992 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5993 only related to authentication.
5994
5995 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5996 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5997 unobvious parameters.
5998
5999 Example :
6000 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6001 backend public_www
6002 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6003 stats enable
6004 stats hide-version
6005 stats scope .
6006 stats uri /admin?stats
6007 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6008 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6009 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6010
6011 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6012 backend private_monitoring
6013 stats enable
6014 stats uri /admin?stats
6015 stats refresh 5s
6016
6017 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6018
6019
6020stats refresh <delay>
6021 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6023 yes | no | yes | yes
6024 Arguments :
6025 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6026 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6027 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6028 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6029 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6030 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6031
6032 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6033 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6034 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6035 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6036
6037 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6038 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6039 unobvious parameters.
6040
6041 Example :
6042 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6043 backend public_www
6044 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6045 stats enable
6046 stats hide-version
6047 stats scope .
6048 stats uri /admin?stats
6049 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6050 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6051 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6052
6053 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6054 backend private_monitoring
6055 stats enable
6056 stats uri /admin?stats
6057 stats refresh 5s
6058
6059 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6060
6061
6062stats scope { <name> | "." }
6063 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6065 yes | no | yes | yes
6066 Arguments :
6067 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6068 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6069 section in which the statement appears.
6070
6071 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6072 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6073 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6074 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6075 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6076 exists.
6077
6078 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6079 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6080 unobvious parameters.
6081
6082 Example :
6083 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6084 backend public_www
6085 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6086 stats enable
6087 stats hide-version
6088 stats scope .
6089 stats uri /admin?stats
6090 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6091 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6092 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6093
6094 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6095 backend private_monitoring
6096 stats enable
6097 stats uri /admin?stats
6098 stats refresh 5s
6099
6100 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6101
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006102
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006103stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006104 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6105 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6106 yes | no | yes | yes
6107
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006108 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006109 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6110
6111 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6112 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6113
6114 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6115 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006116 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006117
6118 Example :
6119 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6120 backend private_monitoring
6121 stats enable
6122 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6123 stats uri /admin?stats
6124 stats refresh 5s
6125
6126 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6127 global section.
6128
6129
6130stats show-legends
6131 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
6132 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6133 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6134 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6135 - IP (socket, server)
6136 - cookie (backend, server)
6137
6138 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6139 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006140 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006141
6142 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6143
6144
6145stats show-node [ <name> ]
6146 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6148 yes | no | yes | yes
6149 Arguments:
6150 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6151 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6152
6153 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6154 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006155 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006156
6157 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6158 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6159 unobvious parameters.
6160
6161 Example:
6162 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6163 backend private_monitoring
6164 stats enable
6165 stats show-node Europe-1
6166 stats uri /admin?stats
6167 stats refresh 5s
6168
6169 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6170 section.
6171
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006172
6173stats uri <prefix>
6174 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6176 yes | no | yes | yes
6177 Arguments :
6178 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6179 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6180 query string.
6181
6182 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6183 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6184 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6185 possible to reach it in the application.
6186
6187 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006188 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006189 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6190 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6191 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6192 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6193
6194 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6195 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6196 an address or a port to statistics only.
6197
6198 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6199 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6200 unobvious parameters.
6201
6202 Example :
6203 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6204 backend public_www
6205 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6206 stats enable
6207 stats hide-version
6208 stats scope .
6209 stats uri /admin?stats
6210 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6211 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6212 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6213
6214 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6215 backend private_monitoring
6216 stats enable
6217 stats uri /admin?stats
6218 stats refresh 5s
6219
6220 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6221
6222
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006223stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6224 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006226 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006227
6228 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006229 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006230 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6231 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6232 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6233
6234 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6235 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6236 the "stick-table" statement.
6237
6238 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6239 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6240 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6241 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6242 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6243
6244 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6245 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6246 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6247 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6248 transformation rules.
6249
6250 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6251 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6252 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6253 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6254 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6255 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6256 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6257
6258 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6259 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6260 ACL based conditions.
6261
6262 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6263 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6264 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6265 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6266
6267 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6268 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6269 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6270 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6271
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006272 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6273 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6274 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6275
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006276 Example :
6277 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6278 # last 30 minutes
6279 backend pop
6280 mode tcp
6281 balance roundrobin
6282 stick store-request src
6283 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6284 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6285 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6286
6287 backend smtp
6288 mode tcp
6289 balance roundrobin
6290 stick match src table pop
6291 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6292 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6293
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006294 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6295 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006296
6297
6298stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6299 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6301 no | no | yes | yes
6302
6303 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6304 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6305 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6306 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6307
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006308 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6309 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6310 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6311
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006312 Examples :
6313 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006314 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006315
6316 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6317 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6318 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6319
6320
6321 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6322 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6323 backend http
6324 mode http
6325 balance roundrobin
6326 stick on src table https
6327 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6328 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6329 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6330
6331 backend https
6332 mode tcp
6333 balance roundrobin
6334 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6335 stick on src
6336 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6337 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6338
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006339 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006340
6341
6342stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6343 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6345 no | no | yes | yes
6346
6347 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006348 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006349 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6350 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6351 server is selected.
6352
6353 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6354 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6355 the "stick-table" statement.
6356
6357 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6358 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6359 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6360 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6361 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6362 address.
6363
6364 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6365 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6366 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6367 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6368 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6369 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6370 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6371 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6372 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6373 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6374
6375 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6376 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6377 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6378 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6379 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6380 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6381 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6382
6383 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6384 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6385 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6386 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6387
6388 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6389 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6390 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6391 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6392 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6393 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006394 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6395 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6396 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6397 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6398 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6399 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006400
6401 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6402 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6403 the request.
6404
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006405 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6406 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6407 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6408
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006409 Example :
6410 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6411 # last 30 minutes
6412 backend pop
6413 mode tcp
6414 balance roundrobin
6415 stick store-request src
6416 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6417 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6418 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6419
6420 backend smtp
6421 mode tcp
6422 balance roundrobin
6423 stick match src table pop
6424 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6425 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6426
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006427 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6428 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006429
6430
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006431stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006432 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6433 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006434 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006436 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006437
6438 Arguments :
6439 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6440 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6441 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6442 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6443
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006444 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6445 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6446 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6447 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6448
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006449 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6450 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6451 instance.
6452
6453 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6454 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6455 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6456 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6457 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6458 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006459 to 32 characters.
6460
6461 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6462 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6463 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6464 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
6465 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6466 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006467
6468 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006469 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6470 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006471 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6472 increase.
6473
6474 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006475 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6476 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6477 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006478
6479 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6480 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6481 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6482 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6483 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6484 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6485 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6486 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6487 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6488 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6489 parameter (see below).
6490
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006491 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6492 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6493 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6494 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6495 soft restart.
6496
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006497 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6498
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006499 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6500 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6501 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6502 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6503 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006504 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006505 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6506 if not expiration delay is specified.
6507
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006508 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6509 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6510 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6511 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006512 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6513 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6514 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6515 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6516 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6517 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6518 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6519 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6520 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6521 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6522 types and their arguments.
6523
6524 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6525 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6526 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6527 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6528
6529 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6530 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6531 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6532 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6533
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006534 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6535 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6536 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6537 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6538 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6539 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6540
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006541 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6542 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6543 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6544 they were received.
6545
6546 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6547 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6548 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6549 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6550 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6551
6552 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6553 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6554 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6555 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6556 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6557
6558 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6559 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6560 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6561
6562 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6563 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6564 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6565 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6566 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6567
6568 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6569 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6570 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6571 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6572 the client side.
6573
6574 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6575 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6576 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6577 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6578 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6579 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6580 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6581
6582 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6583 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6584 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6585 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6586 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6587 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6588 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6589
6590 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6591 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6592 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6593 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
6594 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
6595 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6596
6597 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6598 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
6599 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
6600 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
6601
6602 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6603 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6604 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6605 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6606 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6607 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6608 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6609 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6610 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6611 recommended for better fairness.
6612
6613 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6614 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6615 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6616 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6617
6618 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6619 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6620 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6621 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6622 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6623 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
6624 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
6625 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
6626 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
6627 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006628
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006629 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
6630 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006631 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
6632 reference it.
6633
6634 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
6635 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
6636 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
6637 as an exclusive stickiness.
6638
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006639 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
6640 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
6641 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
6642 something that can be ignored.
6643
6644 Example:
6645 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
6646 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
6647 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
6648 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
6649
6650 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01006651 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006652
6653
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006654stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6655 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6657 no | no | yes | yes
6658
6659 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006660 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006661 describes what elements of the response or connection will
6662 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6663 server is selected.
6664
6665 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6666 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6667 the "stick-table" statement.
6668
6669 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6670 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6671 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
6672 when the response is a SSL server hello.
6673
6674 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6675 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
6676 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
6677 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
6678 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
6679 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006680 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006681 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
6682 rules.
6683
6684 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6685 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6686 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6687 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6688 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6689 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6690 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6691
6692 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
6693 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6694 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
6695 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6696
6697 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
6698 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6699 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6700 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6701 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6702 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006703 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
6704 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6705 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6706 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6707 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6708 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
6709 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
6710 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
6711 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006712
6713 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
6714
6715 Example :
6716 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
6717 backend https
6718 mode tcp
6719 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006720 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006721 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006722
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006723 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
6724 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
6725
6726 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
6727 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6728 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
6729
6730 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
6731 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006732
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006733 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
6734 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
6735 # at offset 44.
6736
6737 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
6738 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
6739
6740 # Learn on response if server hello.
6741 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006742
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006743 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6744 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6745
6746 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6747 extraction.
6748
6749
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006750tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6751 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6753 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006754 Arguments :
6755 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006756 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
6757 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006758
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006759 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006760
6761 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
6762 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006763 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
6764 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
6765 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
6766 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
6767 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
6768 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006769
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006770 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
6771 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
6772 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
6773 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006774
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006775 Three types of actions are supported :
6776 - accept :
6777 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6778 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6779 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006780
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006781 - reject :
6782 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6783 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6784 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
6785 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
6786 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
6787 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
6788 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
6789 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6790 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6791 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6792 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
6793 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006794
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02006795 - expect-proxy layer4 :
6796 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
6797 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
6798 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
6799 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
6800 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
6801 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
6802 hosts.
6803
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006804 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006805 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
6806 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
6807 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006808 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
6809 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006810 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006811 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
6812 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
6813 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
6814 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
6815 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006816
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006817 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006818 <key> is mandatory, and is a pattern extraction rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006819 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006820 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
6821 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
6822 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
6823 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006824
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006825 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6826 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6827 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6828 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006829
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006830 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6831 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6832 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6833 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6834 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006835 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
6836 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
6837 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
6838 layer7 information is extracted.
6839
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006840 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6841 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6842 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6843 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6844 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006845
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006846 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6847 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6848 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006849
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006850 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6851 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6852 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006853
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006854 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006855 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006856 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006857
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006858 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6859 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6860 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006861
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006862 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006863 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
6864 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006865
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02006866 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
6867
6868 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
6869
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006870 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6871
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006872 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006873
6874
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006875tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6876 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006877 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006878 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006879 Arguments :
6880 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006881 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
6882 and "track-sc2". See "tcp-request connection" above for their
Willy Tarreaue25c9172013-05-28 18:32:20 +02006883 signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006884
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006885 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006886
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006887 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6888 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6889 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6890 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6891 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006892
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006893 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6894 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6895 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6896 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6897 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6898 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6899 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6900 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6901 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006902
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006903 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6904 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6905 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6906 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006907
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006908 Three types of actions are supported :
6909 - accept :
6910 - reject :
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006911 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006912
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006913 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6914 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006915
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006916 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6917 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6918 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006919 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. This makes a subtle
6920 difference because tracking rules in "frontend" and "listen" section last for
6921 all the session, as opposed to the backend rules. The difference appears when
6922 some layer 7 information is tracked. While there is nothing mandatory about
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006923 it, it is recommended to use the track-sc0 pointer to track per-frontend
6924 counters and track-sc1 to track per-backend counters, but this is just a
Willy Tarreaue25c9172013-05-28 18:32:20 +02006925 guideline and all counters may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006926
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006927 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006928 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6929 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006930
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006931 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006932 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
6933 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
6934 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
6935 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
6936 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006937
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006938 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
6939 are present when the rule is processed. The current solution for making the
6940 rule engine wait for such information is to set an inspect delay and to
6941 condition its execution with an ACL relying on such information.
6942
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006943 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006944 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6945 # and reject everything else.
6946 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6947 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006948 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006949 tcp-request content reject
6950
6951 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006952 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6953 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6954 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006955 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006956
6957 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6958 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6959 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006960 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006961 tcp-request content reject
6962
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006963 Example:
6964 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
6965 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006966 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1) if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006967
6968 Example:
6969 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
6970 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006971 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006972
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006973 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6974 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6975
6976 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006977 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006978 # protecting all our sites
6979 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006980 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
6981 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006982 ...
6983 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6984
6985 backend http_dynamic
6986 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006987 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006988 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006989 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
6990 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
6991 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006992 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006993
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006994 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006995
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006996 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006997
6998
6999tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7000 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007002 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007003 Arguments :
7004 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7005 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7006 as explained at the top of this document.
7007
7008 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7009 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7010 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7011 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7012 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7013
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007014 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7015 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7016 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7017 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7018
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007019 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7020 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007021 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007022 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007023 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7024 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7025 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7026 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007027
7028 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7029 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7030 it pass through unaffected.
7031
7032 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7033 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7034 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007035 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007036 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7037 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007038 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7039 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7040 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007041
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007042 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007043 "timeout client".
7044
7045
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007046tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7047 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7049 no | no | yes | yes
7050 Arguments :
7051 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007052 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007053
7054 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7055
7056 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7057 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7058 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007059 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7060 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007061
7062 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7063
7064 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7065 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7066 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7067 inserted.
7068
7069 Two types of actions are supported :
7070 - accept :
7071 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7072 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7073 the rules evaluation.
7074
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007075 - close :
7076 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7077 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7078 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7079 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7080 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7081 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
7082 connections which take signifiant resources on servers with certain
7083 protocols.
7084
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007085 - reject :
7086 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7087 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007088 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007089
7090 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7091 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7092 for changing the default action to a reject.
7093
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007094 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7095 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7096 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7097 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007098 period.
7099
7100 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7101
7102 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7103
7104
7105tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7106 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7108 no | no | yes | yes
7109 Arguments :
7110 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7111 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7112 as explained at the top of this document.
7113
7114 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7115
7116
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007117timeout check <timeout>
7118 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7119 established.
7120
7121 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7122 yes | no | yes | yes
7123 Arguments:
7124 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7125 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7126 as explained at the top of this document.
7127
7128 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7129 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7130 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7131 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007132 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7133 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7134 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007135
7136 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7137 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7138
7139 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7140 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007141 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007142
7143 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7144 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7145 forget about it.
7146
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007147 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7148 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007149
7150
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007151timeout client <timeout>
7152timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7153 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7155 yes | yes | yes | no
7156 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007157 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007158 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7159 as explained at the top of this document.
7160
7161 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7162 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7163 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7164 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7165 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7166 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7167 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7168 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007169 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007170 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007171 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7172 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
7173 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007174
7175 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7176 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7177 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7178 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7179 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7180 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7181
7182 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7183 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7184 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7185
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007186 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007187
7188
7189timeout connect <timeout>
7190timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7191 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7193 yes | no | yes | yes
7194 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007195 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007196 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7197 as explained at the top of this document.
7198
7199 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007200 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007201 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007202 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007203 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7204 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007205
7206 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7207 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7208 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7209 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7210 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7211 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7212
7213 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7214 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7215 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7216
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007217 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7218 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007219
7220
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007221timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7222 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7224 yes | yes | yes | yes
7225 Arguments :
7226 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7227 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7228 as explained at the top of this document.
7229
7230 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7231 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7232 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7233 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7234 once the request has started to present itself.
7235
7236 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7237 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7238 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7239 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7240 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7241
7242 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7243 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7244 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7245 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7246
7247 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7248 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7249 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7250 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7251 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007252 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007253
7254 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
7255 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
7256 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
7257 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
7258
7259 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
7260
7261
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007262timeout http-request <timeout>
7263 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
7264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007265 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007266 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007267 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007268 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7269 as explained at the top of this document.
7270
7271 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
7272 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
7273 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
7274 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
7275 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
7276 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
7277 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
7278 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
7279
7280 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7281 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007282 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7283 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007284
7285 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7286 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7287 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7288 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7289 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7290
7291 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007292 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7293 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7294 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007295
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007296 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007297
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007298
7299timeout queue <timeout>
7300 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7301 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7302 yes | no | yes | yes
7303 Arguments :
7304 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7305 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7306 as explained at the top of this document.
7307
7308 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
7309 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
7310 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
7311 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
7312 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
7313
7314 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
7315 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
7316 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
7317 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7318
7319 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7320
7321
7322timeout server <timeout>
7323timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7324 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7326 yes | no | yes | yes
7327 Arguments :
7328 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7329 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7330 as explained at the top of this document.
7331
7332 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7333 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7334 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7335 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7336 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7337 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7338 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7339
7340 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7341 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7342 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7343 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7344 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007345 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007346 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007347 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7348 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7349 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7350 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007351
7352 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7353 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7354 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7355 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7356 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7357 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7358
7359 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
7360 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
7361 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7362
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007363 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007364
7365
7366timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007367 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7369 yes | yes | yes | yes
7370 Arguments :
7371 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
7372 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7373 as explained at the top of this document.
7374
7375 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
7376 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
7377 defines how long it will be maintained open.
7378
7379 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7380 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7381 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
7382 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007383 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007384
7385 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7386
7387
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007388timeout tunnel <timeout>
7389 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
7390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7391 yes | no | yes | yes
7392 Arguments :
7393 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7394 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7395 as explained at the top of this document.
7396
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007397 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007398 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
7399 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
7400 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
7401 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
7402 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
7403 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
7404 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
7405 specified.
7406
7407 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7408 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7409 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
7410 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
7411 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
7412
7413 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7414 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7415 forget about it.
7416
7417 Example :
7418 defaults http
7419 option http-server-close
7420 timeout connect 5s
7421 timeout client 30s
7422 timeout client 30s
7423 timeout server 30s
7424 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
7425
7426 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
7427
7428
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007429transparent (deprecated)
7430 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7431 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007432 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007433 Arguments : none
7434
7435 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
7436 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7437 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7438 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7439 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7440 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7441 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7442 appropriate server.
7443
7444 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
7445
7446 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7447 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7448
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007449 See also: "option transparent"
7450
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007451unique-id-format <string>
7452 Generate a unique ID for each request.
7453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7454 yes | yes | yes | no
7455 Arguments :
7456 <string> is a log-format string.
7457
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007458 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
7459 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
7460 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
7461 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007462
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007463 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
7464 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
7465 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
7466 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
7467 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
7468 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
7469 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
7470 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007471
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007472 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
7473 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007474
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007475 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007476
7477 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
7478
7479 will generate:
7480
7481 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7482
7483 See also: "unique-id-header"
7484
7485unique-id-header <name>
7486 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
7487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7488 yes | yes | yes | no
7489 Arguments :
7490 <name> is the name of the header.
7491
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007492 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
7493 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007494
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007495 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007496
7497 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
7498 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
7499
7500 will generate:
7501
7502 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7503
7504 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007505
7506use_backend <backend> if <condition>
7507use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007508 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7510 no | yes | yes | no
7511 Arguments :
7512 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
7513
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007514 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007515
7516 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
7517 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
7518 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007519 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
7520 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
7521 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
7522 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007523
7524 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
7525 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
7526 assign the backend.
7527
7528 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
7529 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7530 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
7531 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
7532 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
7533 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
7534
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007535 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007536 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007537 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
7538 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
7539 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
7540
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007541 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007542
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007543
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007544use-server <server> if <condition>
7545use-server <server> unless <condition>
7546 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
7547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7548 no | no | yes | yes
7549 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007550 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007551
7552 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
7553
7554 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
7555 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
7556 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
7557
7558 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
7559 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
7560 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
7561 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
7562 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
7563 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
7564 matches will assign the server.
7565
7566 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
7567 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
7568 with the next rules until one matches.
7569
7570 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
7571 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7572 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
7573 according to other persistence mechanisms.
7574
7575 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
7576 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
7577 stripped.
7578
7579 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
7580 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
7581 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
7582 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
7583
7584 Example :
7585 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
7586 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
7587 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
7588 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
7589 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
7590 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
7591 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
7592 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
7593 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
7594
7595 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
7596
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007597
75985. Bind and Server options
7599--------------------------
7600
7601The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
7602depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
7603settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
7604written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
7605described in this section.
7606
7607
76085.1. Bind options
7609-----------------
7610
7611The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
7612as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
7613no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
7614parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
7615while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
7616provided immediately after the setting name.
7617
7618The currently supported settings are the following ones.
7619
7620accept-proxy
7621 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
7622 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
7623 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
7624 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
7625 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
7626 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
7627 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
7628 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
7629 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007630 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
7631 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007632
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02007633alpn <protocols>
7634 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
7635 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
7636 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
7637 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
7638 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
7639 initial NPN extension.
7640
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007641backlog <backlog>
7642 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
7643 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
7644
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007645ecdhe <named curve>
7646 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01007647 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
7648 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007649
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007650ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007651 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7652 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7653 client's certificate.
7654
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007655ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
7656 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7657 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
7658 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
7659 error is ignored.
7660
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007661ciphers <ciphers>
7662 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
7663 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
7664 negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
7665 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
7666 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
7667
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007668crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007669 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7670 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7671 to verify client's certificate.
7672
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007673crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007674 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7675 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
7676 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
7677 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
7678 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
7679 file.
7680
7681 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
7682 are loaded.
7683
7684 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
7685 that directory will be loaded. This directive may be specified multiple times
7686 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
7687 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
7688 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
7689 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
7690 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
7691 www.sub.example.org).
7692
7693 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
7694 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
7695 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
7696 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
7697 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
7698
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02007699 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007700
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007701 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
7702 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
7703 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires a intermediate CA (for
7704 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
7705 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
7706 clients).
7707
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007708crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007709 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
7710 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
7711 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not abored if an error
7712 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007713
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007714crt-list <file>
7715 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007716 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
7717 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007718
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007719 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007720
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007721 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
7722 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
7723 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
7724 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
7725 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
7726 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
7727 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
7728 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007729
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007730defer-accept
7731 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7732 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
7733 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
7734 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
7735 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
7736 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
7737 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
7738 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
7739 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
7740 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
7741 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
7742
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007743force-sslv3
7744 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7745 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
7746 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7747
7748force-tlsv10
7749 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7750 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7751
7752force-tlsv11
7753 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7754 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7755
7756force-tlsv12
7757 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7758 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7759
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007760gid <gid>
7761 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
7762 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7763 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
7764 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
7765 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7766
7767group <group>
7768 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
7769 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
7770 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
7771 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
7772 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7773
7774id <id>
7775 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
7776 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
7777 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
7778 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
7779
7780interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01007781 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
7782 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
7783 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
7784 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
7785 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
7786 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
7787 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007788
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02007789level <level>
7790 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
7791 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
7792 sockets. <level> can be one of :
7793 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
7794 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
7795 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
7796 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
7797 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
7798 counters).
7799 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
7800 all counters).
7801
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007802maxconn <maxconn>
7803 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
7804 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
7805 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
7806 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
7807 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
7808 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
7809 eat all memory.
7810
7811mode <mode>
7812 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
7813 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
7814 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
7815 UNIX sockets.
7816
7817mss <maxseg>
7818 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
7819 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
7820 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
7821 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
7822 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
7823 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
7824 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
7825 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
7826 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
7827 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
7828 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
7829
7830name <name>
7831 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
7832 page.
7833
7834nice <nice>
7835 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
7836 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
7837 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
7838 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
7839 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
7840 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
7841 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
7842 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
7843 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
7844 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
7845 one for an RDP socket.
7846
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007847no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007848 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7849 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instanciated from the listener when
7850 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007851 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7852 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007853
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02007854no-tls-tickets
7855 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7856 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7857 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7858 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
7859
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007860no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007861 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007862 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7863 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7864 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7865 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007866
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007867no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007868 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007869 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7870 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7871 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7872 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007873
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007874no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007875 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007876 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7877 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7878 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7879 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007880
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02007881npn <protocols>
7882 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
7883 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
7884 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
7885 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02007886 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
7887 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02007888
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007889ssl
7890 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7891 enables SSL deciphering on connections instanciated from this listener. A
7892 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
7893 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
7894 to deciphered contents.
7895
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01007896strict-sni
7897 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
7898 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
7899 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
7900 See the "crt" option for more information.
7901
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007902tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01007903 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007904 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
7905 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
7906 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
7907 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
7908 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
7909 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
7910 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02007911 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
7912 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
7913 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007914
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007915transparent
7916 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7917 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
7918 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
7919 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
7920 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
7921 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
7922 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
7923 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
7924 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
7925 so check for support with your vendor.
7926
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01007927v4v6
7928 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
7929 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
7930 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
7931 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
7932 sockets, and is overriden by the "v6only" option.
7933
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01007934v6only
7935 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
7936 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
7937 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01007938 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
7939 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01007940
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007941uid <uid>
7942 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
7943 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7944 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
7945 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
7946 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7947
7948user <user>
7949 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
7950 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7951 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
7952 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
7953 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7954
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007955verify [none|optional|required]
7956 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7957 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
7958 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
7959 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
7960 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007961 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
7962 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7963 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
7964 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007965
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020079665.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007967------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007968
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007969The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
7970which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
7971arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
7972settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
7973after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
7974Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
7975address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007976
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007977 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007978 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007979
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007980The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007981
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007982addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007983 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
7984 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
7985 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
7986 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
7987 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007988
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007989 Supported in default-server: No
7990
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09007991agent-check
7992 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
7993 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP
7994 connection to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter" and reading
7995 an ASCII string. The string should have one of the following forms:
7996
7997 * An ASCII representation of an positive integer percentage.
7998 e.g. "75%"
7999
8000 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
8001 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts.
8002
8003 * The string "drain".
8004
8005 This will cause the weight of a server to be set to 0, and thus it will
8006 not accept any new connections other than those that are accepted via
8007 persistence.
8008
8009 * The string "down", optionally followed by a description string.
8010
8011 Mark the server as down and log the description string as the reason.
8012
8013 * The string "stopped", optionally followed by a description string.
8014
8015 This currently has the same behaviour as "down".
8016
8017 * The string "fail", optionally followed by a description string.
8018
8019 This currently has the same behaviour as "down".
8020
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008021 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8022 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
8023 parameter.
8024
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008025 Requires the ""agent-port" parameter to be set.
8026 See also the "agent-check" parameter.
8027
8028 Supported in default-server: No
8029
8030agent-inter <delay>
8031 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8032 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8033
8034 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8035 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8036 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8037 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8038 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8039 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8040 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8041 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8042 of backends use the same servers.
8043
8044 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8045
8046 Supported in default-server: Yes
8047
8048agent-port <port>
8049 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8050
8051 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8052
8053 Supported in default-server: Yes
8054
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008055backup
8056 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8057 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8058 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8059 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8060 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8061 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008062
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008063 Supported in default-server: No
8064
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008065ca-file <cafile>
8066 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8067 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8068 server's certificate.
8069
8070 Supported in default-server: No
8071
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008072check
8073 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008074 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8075 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8076 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8077 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8078 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8079 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8080 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008081 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8082 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8083 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008084
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008085 Supported in default-server: No
8086
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008087check-send-proxy
8088 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8089 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8090 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8091 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8092 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8093 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8094 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8095
8096 Supported in default-server: No
8097
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008098check-ssl
8099 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8100 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8101 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8102 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
8103 inserts an SSL transport layer below the ckecks, so that a simple TCP connect
8104 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8105 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8106 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8107 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8108
8109 Supported in default-server: No
8110
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008111ciphers <ciphers>
8112 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
8113 is negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
8114 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8115 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8116 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8117 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8118 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8119 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8120
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008121 Supported in default-server: No
8122
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008123cookie <value>
8124 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8125 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8126 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8127 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8128 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8129 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8130 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8131
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008132 Supported in default-server: No
8133
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008134crl-file <crlfile>
8135 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8136 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8137 to verify server's certificate.
8138
8139 Supported in default-server: No
8140
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02008141crt <cert>
8142 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8143 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
8144 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
8145 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
8146 certificate request.
8147
8148 Supported in default-server: No
8149
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02008150disabled
8151 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
8152 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
8153 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
8154 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
8155 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
8156
8157 Supported in default-server: No
8158
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008159error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008160 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
8161 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
8162 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008163
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008164 Supported in default-server: Yes
8165
8166 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008167
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008168fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008169 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
8170 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
8171 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
8172
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008173 Supported in default-server: Yes
8174
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008175force-sslv3
8176 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8177 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
8178 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8179
8180 Supported in default-server: No
8181
8182force-tlsv10
8183 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8184 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8185
8186 Supported in default-server: No
8187
8188force-tlsv11
8189 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8190 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8191
8192 Supported in default-server: No
8193
8194force-tlsv12
8195 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8196 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8197
8198 Supported in default-server: No
8199
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008200id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008201 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
8202 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
8203 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008204
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008205 Supported in default-server: No
8206
8207inter <delay>
8208fastinter <delay>
8209downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008210 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
8211 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8212 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
8213 between checks depending on the server state :
8214
8215 Server state | Interval used
8216 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8217 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
8218 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8219 Transitionally UP (going down), |
8220 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8221 or yet unchecked. |
8222 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8223 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8224 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008226 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
8227 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
8228 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
8229 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008230 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8231 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8232 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8233 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8234 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008235
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008236 Supported in default-server: Yes
8237
8238maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008239 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
8240 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
8241 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
8242 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
8243 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
8244 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
8245 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
8246 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
8247
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008248 Supported in default-server: Yes
8249
8250maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008251 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
8252 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
8253 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
8254 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
8255 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
8256 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
8257 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
8258
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008259 Supported in default-server: Yes
8260
8261minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008262 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
8263 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
8264 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
8265 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
8266 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
8267 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008268 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008269 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008270
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008271 Supported in default-server: Yes
8272
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008273no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008274 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
8275 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008276 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008277
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008278 Supported in default-server: No
8279
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02008280no-tls-tickets
8281 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8282 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8283 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8284 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
8285
8286 Supported in default-server: No
8287
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008288no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008289 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008290 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8291 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008292 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8293 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008294
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008295 Supported in default-server: No
8296
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008297no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008298 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008299 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8300 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008301 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8302 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008303
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008304 Supported in default-server: No
8305
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008306no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008307 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008308 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8309 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008310 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8311 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008312
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008313 Supported in default-server: No
8314
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09008315non-stick
8316 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
8317 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
8318 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
8319
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008320 Supported in default-server: No
8321
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008322observe <mode>
8323 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
8324 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
8325 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
8326 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
8327 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
8328 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01008329 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008330
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008331 Supported in default-server: No
8332
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008333 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
8334
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008335on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008336 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
8337 Currently, four modes are available:
8338 - fastinter: force fastinter
8339 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
8340 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
8341 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
8342 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
8343
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008344 Supported in default-server: Yes
8345
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008346 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
8347
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008348on-marked-down <action>
8349 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
8350 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008351 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
8352 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
8353 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
8354 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
8355 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
8356 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
8357 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
8358 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008359
8360 Actions are disabled by default
8361
8362 Supported in default-server: Yes
8363
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008364on-marked-up <action>
8365 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
8366 Currently one action is available:
8367 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
8368 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
8369 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
8370 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
8371 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
8372 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
8373 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
8374 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
8375
8376 Actions are disabled by default
8377
8378 Supported in default-server: Yes
8379
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008380port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008381 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
8382 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
8383 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
8384 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
8385 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
8386 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
8387
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008388 Supported in default-server: Yes
8389
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008390redir <prefix>
8391 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
8392 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
8393 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
8394 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
8395 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
8396 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
8397 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
8398 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008399 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008400 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
8401 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
8402 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
8403 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
8404 loop between the client and HAProxy!
8405
8406 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
8407
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008408 Supported in default-server: No
8409
8410rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008411 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
8412 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
8413 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
8414
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008415 Supported in default-server: Yes
8416
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008417send-proxy
8418 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
8419 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
8420 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
8421 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
8422 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
8423 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
8424 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
8425 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
8426 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008427 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
8428 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
8429 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
8430 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
8431 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008432
8433 Supported in default-server: No
8434
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008435slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008436 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
8437 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
8438 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
8439 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
8440 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
8441 parameters :
8442
8443 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
8444 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
8445
8446 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
8447 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
8448 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
8449 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
8450
8451 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
8452 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
8453 seen as failed.
8454
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008455 Supported in default-server: Yes
8456
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008457source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008458source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008459source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008460 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
8461 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
8462 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
8463 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
8464
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008465 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
8466 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
8467 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
8468 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
8469 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
8470 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
8471 server.
8472
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008473 Supported in default-server: No
8474
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008475ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008476 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
8477 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
8478 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
8479 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
8480 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
8481 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
8482 See the "check-ssl" optino to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008483
8484 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008485
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008486track [<proxy>/]<server>
8487 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
8488 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
8489 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
8490 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
8491 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
8492
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008493 Supported in default-server: No
8494
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008495verify [none|required]
8496 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8497 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. This is the default. In the
8498 other case, The certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from
8499 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008500 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
8501 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
8502 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008503
8504 Supported in default-server: No
8505
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07008506verifyhost <hostname>
8507 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
8508 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
8509 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
8510 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
8511 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
8512 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
8513
8514 Supported in default-server: No
8515
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008516weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008517 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
8518 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
8519 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02008520 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
8521 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
8522 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
8523 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
8524 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
8525 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008526
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008527 Supported in default-server: Yes
8528
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008529
85306. HTTP header manipulation
8531---------------------------
8532
8533In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
8534response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
8535request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
8536which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
8537against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
8538to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
8539passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
8540headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
8541never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
8542
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02008543There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
8544(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
8545rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
8546messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
8547in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008548happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02008549add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
8550normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
8551
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008552This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
8553in section 4.2 :
8554
8555 - reqadd <string>
8556 - reqallow <search>
8557 - reqiallow <search>
8558 - reqdel <search>
8559 - reqidel <search>
8560 - reqdeny <search>
8561 - reqideny <search>
8562 - reqpass <search>
8563 - reqipass <search>
8564 - reqrep <search> <replace>
8565 - reqirep <search> <replace>
8566 - reqtarpit <search>
8567 - reqitarpit <search>
8568 - rspadd <string>
8569 - rspdel <search>
8570 - rspidel <search>
8571 - rspdeny <search>
8572 - rspideny <search>
8573 - rsprep <search> <replace>
8574 - rspirep <search> <replace>
8575
8576With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
8577is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
8578parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
8579prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
8580Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
8581
8582 \t for a tab
8583 \r for a carriage return (CR)
8584 \n for a new line (LF)
8585 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
8586 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
8587 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
8588 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
8589 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
8590
8591The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
8592portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
8593above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
8594regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
85959 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
8596is very common to users of the "sed" program.
8597
8598The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
8599after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
8600
8601Notes related to these keywords :
8602---------------------------------
8603 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
8604 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
8605 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
8606
8607 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
8608 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
8609 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
8610
8611 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
8612 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
8613 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
8614 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
8615 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
8616
8617 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
8618 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
8619 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
8620 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
8621 useless headers before adding new ones.
8622
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008623 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008624 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
8625
8626 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
8627 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
8628 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
8629
8630 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
8631 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008632 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008633
8634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020086357. Using ACLs and fetching samples
8636----------------------------------
8637
8638Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
8639client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
8640The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
8641these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
8642but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
8643data called patterns.
8644
8645
86467.1. ACL basics
8647---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008648
8649The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
8650content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
8651from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
8652simple :
8653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008654 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008655 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008656 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
8657 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008659The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
8660adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008661
8662In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
8663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008664 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008665
8666This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
8667Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
8668and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008669an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
8670conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
8671as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
8672are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008673
8674ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
8675'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
8676which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
8677
8678There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
8679performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
8680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008681The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
8682specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
8683this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008684methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
8685ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008686
8687Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
8688 - boolean
8689 - integer (signed or unsigned)
8690 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
8691 - string
8692 - data block
8693
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008694Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
8695converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
8696would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
8697The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
8698which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
8699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008700The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
8701 - boolean
8702 - integer or integer range
8703 - IP address / network
8704 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
8705 - regular expression
8706 - hex block
8707
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008708The following ACL flags are currently supported :
8709
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008710 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
8711 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008712 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008713 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
8714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008715The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
8716read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
8717if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
8718lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
8719will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
8720beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
8721a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
8722lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
8723exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
8724
8725Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
8726loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
8727
8728 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
8729
8730In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
8731the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
8732case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
8733as well.
8734
8735The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
8736sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
8737do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
8738methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
8739is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
8740obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
8741followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
8742default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
8743that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
8744string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
8745
8746There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
8747sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
8748be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008749
8750 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
8751 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008752 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
8753 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
8754 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
8755 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008756
8757 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
8758 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008759 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008760
8761 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008762 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008763
8764 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008765 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008766
8767 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
8768 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
8769
8770 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
8771 binary or string samples.
8772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008773 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
8774 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008776 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
8777 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
8778 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008780 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
8781 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008783 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
8784 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008786 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
8787 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008789 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
8790 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008791 This may be used with binary or string samples.
8792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008793 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
8794 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
8795 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008796
8797For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
8798request, it is possible to do :
8799
8800 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
8801
8802In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
8803buffer, one would use the following acl :
8804
8805 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
8806
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008807On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
8808possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
8809
8810 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
8811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008812All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
8813criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
8814method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
8815to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
8816criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
8817the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008819If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
8820the mathing method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method. For
8821example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008823 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
8824 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
8825 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
8826 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008827
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008828
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008829The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample types
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008830and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
8831combination the name of the matching method to be used, prefixed with "*" when
8832the method is implicit and will work by default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008834 +-------------------------------------------------+
8835 | Input sample type |
8836 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8837 | pattern type | boolean | integer | IP | string | binary |
8838 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8839 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
8840 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008841 | none (boolean value) | *bool | bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008842 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008843 | integer (value) | int | *int | int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008844 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008845 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008846 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008847 | IP address | | | *ip | ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008848 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008849 | exact string | str | str | str | str | str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008850 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008851 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008852 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008853 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008854 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008855 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008856 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008857 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008858 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008859 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008860 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008861 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008862 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8863 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
8864 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008865
8866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020088677.1.1. Matching booleans
8868------------------------
8869
8870In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
8871Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
8872When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
8873that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
8874
8875Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
8876return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
8877"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
8878
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020088807.1.2. Matching integers
8881------------------------
8882
8883Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
8884enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
8885to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
8886
8887Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
8888matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
8889lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008890
8891For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
8892unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
8893representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
8894
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008895As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
8896two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
8897instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
8898ranges and operators.
8899
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008900For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008901operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
8902Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
8903of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008904
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008905Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008906
8907 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
8908 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
8909 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
8910 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
8911 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
8912
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008913For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008914
8915 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
8916
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008917This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
8918
8919 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
8920
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020089227.1.3. Matching strings
8923-----------------------
8924
8925String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
8926different forms :
8927
8928 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
8929 patterns ;
8930
8931 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
8932 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
8933
8934 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
8935 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
8936
8937 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
8938 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
8939
8940 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
8941 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
8942 matches.
8943
8944 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
8945 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
8946 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008947
8948String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
8949exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
8950characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
8951string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
8952to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008953before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008954
8955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020089567.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
8957---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008958
8959Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
8960they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
8961possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
8962passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
8963the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008964the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
8965match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008966
8967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020089687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
8969-------------------------------------
8970
8971It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
8972not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
8973a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
8974to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
8975digits may be used upper or lower case.
8976
8977Example :
8978 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
8979 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
8980
8981
89827.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
8983---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008984
8985IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
8986netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
8987within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008988host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008989difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
8990at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
8991does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
8992parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008993
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008994IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
8995Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
8996trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
8997IPv6 patterns.
8998
8999HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9000following situations :
9001 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9002 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9003 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9004 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9005 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9006 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9007 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9008 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9009 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9010 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009012
90137.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9014----------------------------------
9015
9016Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9017combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9018
9019 - AND (implicit)
9020 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9021 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009023A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009025 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009027Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9028indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009030For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9031"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9032requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9033is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
9034
9035 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9036 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9037 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9038 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
9039
9040To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9041and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
9042
9043 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9044 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9045 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9046 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
9047
9048 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9049 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9050 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9051 use_backend www if host_www
9052
9053It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9054expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9055be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
9056the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
9057
9058 The following rule :
9059
9060 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9061 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9062
9063 Can also be written that way :
9064
9065 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9066
9067It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9068to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9069simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9070sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9071good use is the following :
9072
9073 With named ACLs :
9074
9075 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9076 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9077 monitor fail if site_dead
9078
9079 With anonymous ACLs :
9080
9081 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9082
9083See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
9084
9085
90867.3. Fetching samples
9087---------------------
9088
9089Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
9090against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
9091sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
9092ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
9093of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
9094available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
9095
9096This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
9097Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
9098compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
9099deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
9100
9101The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
9102matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
9103method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
9104indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
9105
9106As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
9107when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
9108mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
9109the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
9110ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
9111
9112Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
9113multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
9114when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
9115incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
9116are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
9117is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
9118all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
9119
9120Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
9121 - name
9122 - name(arg1)
9123 - name(arg1,arg2)
9124
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009125Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
9126of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
9127is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
9128was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
9129has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
9130unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
9131
9132These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
9133sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
9134the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
9135support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009136
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009137The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009139 lower Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed
9140 after a string sample fetch function or after a transformation
9141 keyword returning a string type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009142
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009143 upper Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed
9144 after a string sample fetch function or after a transformation
9145 keyword returning a string type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009146
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009147 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for
9148 lookups and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within
9149 a certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
9150 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
9151 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
9152
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02009153 http_date([<offset>])
9154 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to
9155 a string representing this date in a format suitable for use
9156 in HTTP header fields. If an offset value is specified, then
9157 it is a number of seconds that is added to the date before the
9158 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit
9159 Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined
9160 with a positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the
9161 offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009162
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009163 map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9164 map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9165 map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9166 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type>
9167 matching method, and return the associated value converted to
9168 the type <output_type>. If the input value cannot be found in
9169 the <map_file>, the converter returns the <default_value>. If
9170 the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and acts
9171 as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is
9172 not set, it defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type>
9173 is not set, it defaults to "str". For convenience, the "map"
9174 keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a string to another
9175 string. The following array contains contains the list of all
9176 the map* converters.
9177
9178 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP
9179 addresses and strings are stored in trees, so the first of the
9180 finest match will be used. Other keys are stored in lists, so
9181 the first matching occurrence will be used.
9182
9183 +----+----------+---------+-------------+------------+
9184 | `-_ out | | | |
9185 | input `-_ | str | int | ip |
9186 | / match `-_ | | | |
9187 +---------------+---------+-------------+------------+
9188 | str / str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip |
9189 | str / sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip |
9190 | str / dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip |
9191 | str / dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip |
9192 | str / end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip |
9193 | str / reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip |
9194 | int / int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip |
9195 | ip / ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip |
9196 +---------------+---------+-------------+------------+
9197
9198 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start
9199 with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and
9200 spaces are stripped. The key is then the first "word" (series
9201 of non-space/tabs characters), and the value is what follows
9202 this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
9203 trailing spaces/tabs.
9204
9205 Example :
9206
9207 # this is a comment and is ignored
9208 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
9209 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
9210 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
9211 | | | `----------- value
9212 | | `--------------------- middle spaces ignored
9213 | `---------------------------- key
9214 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
9215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020092167.3.1. Fetching samples from internal states
9217--------------------------------------------
9218
9219A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
9220not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
9221"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
9222The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
9223
9224always_false : boolean
9225 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9226 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9227
9228always_true : boolean
9229 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9230 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9231
9232avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009233 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009234 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
9235 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
9236 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
9237 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
9238 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
9239 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
9240 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
9241 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
9242 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
9243 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
9244 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
9245 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
9246 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01009247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009248be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009249 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
9250 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
9251 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
9252 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
9253 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009255be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
9256 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9257 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9258 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
9259 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
9260 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
9261 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009262
9263 Example :
9264 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
9265 backend dynamic
9266 mode http
9267 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
9268 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009270connslots([<backend>]) : integer
9271 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
9272 still available in the backend, by totalizing the maximum amount of
9273 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
9274 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -05009275
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009276 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009277 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009278 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
9279
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009280 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
9281 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009282
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009283 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009284 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009285 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009286 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
9287 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009288 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009289 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009290
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009291 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
9292 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009293 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009294 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009295
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009296date([<offset>]) : integer
9297 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
9298 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
9299 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
9300 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02009301 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
9302
9303 Example :
9304
9305 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
9306 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009307
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +02009308env(<name>) : string
9309 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
9310 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
9311 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
9312 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
9313 certain way.
9314
9315 Examples :
9316 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
9317 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
9318
9319 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
9320 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
9321
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009322fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
9323 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009324 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
9325 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009326 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
9327 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
9328 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
9329 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
9330 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009331
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009332fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
9333 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9334 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9335 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
9336 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
9337 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
9338 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
9339 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
9340 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009341
9342 Example :
9343 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
9344 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
9345 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
9346 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
9347 frontend mail
9348 bind :25
9349 mode tcp
9350 maxconn 100
9351 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
9352 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
9353 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
9354 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009355
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009356nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
9357 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
9358 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
9359 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009360 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
9361 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
9362 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009364queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009365 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
9366 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
9367 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009368 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
9369 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
9370 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
9371 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
9372 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
9373
9374srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
9375 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
9376 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
9377 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
9378 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
9379 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
9380 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
9381 methods.
9382
9383srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
9384 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
9385 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
9386 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
9387 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
9388 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
9389 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
9390 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
9391
9392srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
9393 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9394 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
9395 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mosly
9396 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
9397 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
9398 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
9399 overloading servers).
9400
9401 Example :
9402 # Redirect to a separate back
9403 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
9404 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
9405 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
9406
9407table_avl([<table>]) : integer
9408 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
9409 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
9410
9411table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9412 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
9413 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
9414 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
9415
9416
94177.3.2. Fetching samples at Layer 4
9418----------------------------------
9419
9420The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
9421closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
9422methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
9423sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
9424TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009425the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
9426counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
9427"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009428argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
9429the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
9430this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009431
9432be_id : integer
9433 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
9434 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
9435
9436dst : ip
9437 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
9438 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
9439 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9440 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
9441 RFC 4291.
9442
9443dst_conn : integer
9444 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
9445 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
9446 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
9447 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
9448 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
9449 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
9450 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
9451 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009453dst_port : integer
9454 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
9455 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
9456 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
9457 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
9458 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
9459 an HTTP header.
9460
9461fe_id : integer
9462 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
9463 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
9464 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
9465
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009466sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9467sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9468sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9469sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009470 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
9471 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9472 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
9473
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009474sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9475sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9476sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9477sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009478 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
9479 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9480 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
9481
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009482sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9483sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9484sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9485sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009486 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
9487 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009488 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
9489 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
9490 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009491
9492 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
9493 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009494 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
9495 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
9496 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009497 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
9498 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9499
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009500sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9501sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9502sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9503sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009504 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
9505 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
9506
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009507sc_conn_cur(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9508sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
9509sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
9510sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009511 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
9512 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
9513 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
9514
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009515sc_conn_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9516sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9517sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9518sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009519 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
9520 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
9521 See also src_conn_rate.
9522
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009523sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9524sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9525sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9526sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009527 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009528 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009529
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009530sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9531sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
9532sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
9533sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009534 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9535 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
9536 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009537 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
9538 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
9539 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009540
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009541sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9542sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9543sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9544sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009545 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
9546 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
9547 See also src_http_err_cnt.
9548
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009549sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9550sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9551sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9552sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009553 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
9554 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
9555 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
9556 src_http_err_rate.
9557
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009558sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9559sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9560sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9561sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009562 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
9563 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
9564 src_http_req_cnt.
9565
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009566sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9567sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9568sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9569sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009570 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
9571 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
9572 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
9573 src_http_req_rate.
9574
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009575sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9576sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9577sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9578sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009579 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009580 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
9581 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
9582 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
9583 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009584
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009585 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
9586 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009587 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9588
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009589sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9590sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9591sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9592sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009593 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
9594 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
9595 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
9596 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
9597
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009598sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9599sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9600sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9601sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009602 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
9603 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
9604 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
9605 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
9606
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009607sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9608sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9609sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9610sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009611 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
9612 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
9613 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
9614 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009615 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009616 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
9617
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009618sc_sess_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9619sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9620sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9621sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009622 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
9623 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
9624 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
9625 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
9626 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009627 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009628
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009629sc_tracked(<ctr>,[<table>]) : boolean
9630sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
9631sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
9632sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +02009633 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
9634 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
9635 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
9636
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009637sc_trackers(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9638sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
9639sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
9640sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009641 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
9642 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009643 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009644 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
9645 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009646 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
9647 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
9648 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009650so_id : integer
9651 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
9652 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
9653 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009655src : ip
9656 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
9657 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
9658 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
9659 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
9660 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
9661 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
9662 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009663
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009664 Example:
9665 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
9666 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
9667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009668src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9669 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
9670 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
9671 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009672 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009674src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9675 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
9676 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009677 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009678 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009680src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9681 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
9682 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9683 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
9684 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
9685 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
9686 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009687
9688 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
9689 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
9690 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
9691 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009692 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009693 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
9694 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009696src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009697 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009698 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009699 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009700 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009702src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009703 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009704 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
9705 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009706 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009708src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9709 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
9710 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9711 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009712 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009714src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009715 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009716 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009717 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009718 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009720src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009721 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009722 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009723 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
9724 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009725 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
9726 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
9727 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009729src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9730 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
9731 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009732 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009733 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009734 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009736src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9737 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
9738 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9739 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
9740 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009741 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009743src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9744 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
9745 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
9746 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009747 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009748
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009749src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9750 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
9751 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
9752 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009753 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009754 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009756src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9757 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
9758 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9759 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009760 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009761 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
9762 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009763
9764 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009765 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009766 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009768src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9769 Returns the amount of data received from the incoming connection's source
9770 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9771 measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address
9772 is not found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009773 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also
9774 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009776src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9777 Returns the amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source address
9778 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009779 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
9780 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009781 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009783src_port : integer
9784 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
9785 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
9786 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
9787 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009789src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9790 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009791 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9792 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
9793 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009794 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009796src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9797 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
9798 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9799 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
9800 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009801 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009803src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9804 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
9805 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
9806 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
9807 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
9808 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
9809 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
9810 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
9811 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009812
9813 Example :
9814 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
9815 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
9816 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
9817 listen ssh
9818 bind :22
9819 mode tcp
9820 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009821 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009822 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009823 server local 127.0.0.1:22
9824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009825srv_id : integer
9826 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
9827 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
9828 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02009829
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01009830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020098317.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 5
9832----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02009833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009834The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
9835closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
9836when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
9837usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
9838future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negociations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02009839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009840ssl_c_ca_err : integer
9841 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9842 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
9843 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
9844 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
9845 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02009846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009847ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
9848 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9849 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
9850 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
9851 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009852
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009853ssl_c_err : integer
9854 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9855 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
9856 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
9857 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
9858 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009859
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009860ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9861 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9862 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
9863 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9864 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9865 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
9866 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9867 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9868 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009870 ACL derivatives :
9871 ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009873ssl_c_key_alg : string
9874 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
9875 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9876 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009877
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009878 ACL derivatives :
9879 ssl_c_key_alg : exact string match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02009880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009881ssl_c_notafter : string
9882 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
9883 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9884 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02009885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009886 ACL derivatives :
9887 ssl_c_notafter : exact string match
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02009888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009889ssl_c_notbefore : string
9890 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
9891 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9892 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009893
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009894 ACL derivatives :
9895 ssl_c_notbefore : exact string match
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009897ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9898 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9899 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
9900 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9901 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9902 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
9903 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9904 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9905 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009907 ACL derivatives :
9908 ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009910ssl_c_serial : binary
9911 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
9912 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
9913 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009915 ACL derivatives :
9916 ssl_c_serial : hex block match
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009918ssl_c_sha1 : binary
9919 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
9920 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
9921 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009923ssl_c_sig_alg : string
9924 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
9925 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9926 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009928 ACL derivatives :
9929 ssl_c_sig_alg : exact string match
9930
9931ssl_c_used : boolean
9932 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
9933 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009935ssl_c_verify : integer
9936 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
9937 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
9938 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
9939 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009940
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009941ssl_c_version : integer
9942 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
9943 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009945ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9946 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9947 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
9948 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9949 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009950 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009951 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9952 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9953 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009955 ACL derivatives :
9956 ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009958ssl_f_key_alg : string
9959 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
9960 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
9961 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009963 ACL derivatives :
9964 ssl_f_key_alg : exact string match
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01009965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009966ssl_f_notafter : string
9967 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
9968 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9969 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009971 ACL derivatives :
9972 ssl_f_notafter : exact string match
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009974ssl_f_notbefore : string
9975 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
9976 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9977 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009979 ACL derivatives :
9980 ssl_f_notbefore : exact string match
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009982ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9983 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9984 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
9985 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9986 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9987 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
9988 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9989 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9990 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009992 ACL derivatives :
9993 ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009995ssl_f_serial : binary
9996 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
9997 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
9998 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009999
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010000 ACL derivatives :
10001 ssl_f_serial : hex block match
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +020010002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010003ssl_f_sig_alg : string
10004 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10005 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10006 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010008 ACL derivatives :
10009 ssl_f_sig_alg : exact string match
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +020010010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010011ssl_f_version : integer
10012 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10013 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10014
10015ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010016 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10017 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
10018 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
10019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010020 Example :
10021 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
10022 listen http-https
10023 bind :80
10024 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
10025 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
10026
10027ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
10028 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
10029 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10030
10031ssl_fc_alpn : string
10032 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negociation field from an
10033 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
10034 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
10035 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
10036 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
10037 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
10038 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
10039 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
10040 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
10041
10042 ACL derivatives :
10043 ssl_fc_alpn : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010044
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010045ssl_fc_cipher : string
10046 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
10047 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010049 ACL derivatives :
10050 ssl_fc_cipher : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010052ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010053 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
10054 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010055 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
10056 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
10057 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
10058 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010060ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
10061 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020010062 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
10063 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
10064 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10065 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010067ssl_fc_npn : string
10068 This extracts the Next Protocol Negociation field from an incoming connection
10069 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
10070 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
10071 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10072 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
10073 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
10074 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
10075 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020010076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010077 ACL derivatives :
10078 ssl_fc_npn : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010080ssl_fc_protocol : string
10081 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
10082 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010084 ACL derivatives :
10085 ssl_fc_protocol : exact string match
10086
10087ssl_fc_session_id : binary
10088 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
10089 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
10090 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
10091 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010092
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010093ssl_fc_sni : string
10094 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
10095 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
10096 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
10097 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
10098 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
10099
10100 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
10101 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
10102 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020010103 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
10104 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010106 ACL derivatives :
10107 ssl_fc_sni : exact string match
10108 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
10109 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010110
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010111ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
10112 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
10113 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010114
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200101167.3.4. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
10117------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010119Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
10120sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
10121only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
10122For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
10123be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
10124can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
10125sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
10126for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
10127content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010129payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
10130 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
10131 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
10132 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010134payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
10135 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
10136 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
10137 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010139req.len : integer
10140req_len : integer (deprecated)
10141 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10142 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10143 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10144 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10145 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10146 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10147 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
10148 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010150req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10151 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010152 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10153 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10154 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10155 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010157 ACL alternatives :
10158 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010160req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10161 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10162 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10163 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
10164 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010165
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010166 ACL alternatives :
10167 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010169 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010171req.proto_http : boolean
10172req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
10173 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
10174 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
10175 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
10176 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
10177 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
10178 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
10179 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010181 Example:
10182 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10183 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10184 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010185 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010187req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
10188rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10189 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
10190 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
10191 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
10192 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
10193 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
10194 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
10195 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010197 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
10198 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
10199 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
10200 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
10201 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
10202 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010204 ACL derivatives :
10205 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010207 Example :
10208 listen tse-farm
10209 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
10210 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10211 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10212 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10213 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10214 persist rdp-cookie
10215 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
10216 # This is only useful makes sense if
10217 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
10218 stick-table type string size 204800
10219 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
10220 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10221 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010223 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
10224 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010226req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
10227rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
10228 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
10229 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
10230 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
10231 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010233 ACL derivatives :
10234 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010236req.ssl_hello_type : integer
10237req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10238 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10239 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
10240 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10241 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10242 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
10243 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10244 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010246req.ssl_sni : string
10247req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
10248 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
10249 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
10250 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
10251 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10252 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10253 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
10254 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
10255 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
10256 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
10257 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
10258 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
10259 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010261 ACL derivatives :
10262 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010264 Examples :
10265 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
10266 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10267 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
10268 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
10269 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010270
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010271res.ssl_hello_type : integer
10272rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10273 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10274 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
10275 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10276 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10277 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
10278 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10279 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020010280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010281req.ssl_ver : integer
10282req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
10283 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
10284 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
10285 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
10286 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
10287 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10288 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10289 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
10290 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
10291 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010293 ACL derivatives :
10294 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010295
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020010296res.len : integer
10297 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10298 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10299 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10300 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10301 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10302 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10303 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
10304 content inspection.
10305
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010306res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10307 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010308 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10309 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10310 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10311 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010313res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10314 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10315 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10316 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
10317 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010319 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010320
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010321wait_end : boolean
10322 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
10323 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
10324 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
10325 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
10326 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
10327 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
10328 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
10329 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010331 Examples :
10332 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
10333 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
10334 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010336 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
10337 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10338 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
10339 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
10340 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
10341 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
10342 tcp-request content reject
10343
10344
103457.3.5. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
10346--------------------------------------
10347
10348It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
10349This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
10350data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
10351its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
10352HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
10353content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
10354to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
10355more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
10356response are indexed.
10357
10358base : string
10359 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
10360 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
10361 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
10362 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
10363 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
10364 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
10365 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
10366 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
10367
10368 ACL derivatives :
10369 base : exact string match
10370 base_beg : prefix match
10371 base_dir : subdir match
10372 base_dom : domain match
10373 base_end : suffix match
10374 base_len : length match
10375 base_reg : regex match
10376 base_sub : substring match
10377
10378base32 : integer
10379 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
10380 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
10381 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
10382 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
10383
10384base32+src : binary
10385 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
10386 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
10387 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
10388 per-URL counters.
10389
10390req.cook([<name>]) : string
10391cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10392 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10393 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
10394 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
10395 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
10396 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
10397 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
10398 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
10399 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
10400
10401 ACL derivatives :
10402 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
10403 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
10404 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
10405 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
10406 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
10407 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
10408 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
10409 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010410
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010411req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10412cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10413 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
10414 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010416req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
10417cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10418 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10419 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
10420 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
10421 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010423cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10424 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10425 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
10426 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
10427 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
10428 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
10429 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
10430 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
10431 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
10432 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
10433 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010435hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10436 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
10437 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
10438 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
10439 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
10440 unambiguouslly apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010442req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
10443 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
10444 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
10445 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10446 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10447 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10448 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
10449 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
10450 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010452req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10453 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
10454 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10455 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
10456 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010458req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10459 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
10460 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
10461 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10462 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10463 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10464 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
10465 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
10466 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
10467 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
10468 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
10469 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010471 ACL derivatives :
10472 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
10473 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
10474 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
10475 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
10476 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
10477 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
10478 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
10479 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
10480
10481req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10482hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
10483 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
10484 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
10485 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
10486 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
10487 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
10488 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
10489 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
10490 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
10491 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
10492
10493req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
10494hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
10495 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
10496 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
10497 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
10498 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
10499 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
10500 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10501 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
10502 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
10503
10504req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
10505hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
10506 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
10507 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
10508 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
10509 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10510 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10511 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10512 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
10513
10514http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
10515 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
10516 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
10517 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
10518 basic auth is supported.
10519
10520http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group
10521 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
10522 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist, and
10523 whether that username belongs to one of the groups supplied in ACL patterns.
10524 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
10525 basic auth is supported.
10526
10527 ACL derivatives :
10528 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : user group match
10529
10530http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020010531 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
10532 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010533 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
10534 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020010535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010536method : integer + string
10537 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
10538 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
10539 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
10540 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
10541 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
10542 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
10543 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010545 ACL derivatives :
10546 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010548 Example :
10549 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
10550 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
10551 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010553path : string
10554 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
10555 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
10556 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
10557 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
10558 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
10559 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
10560 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010562 ACL derivatives :
10563 path : exact string match
10564 path_beg : prefix match
10565 path_dir : subdir match
10566 path_dom : domain match
10567 path_end : suffix match
10568 path_len : length match
10569 path_reg : regex match
10570 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010572req.ver : string
10573req_ver : string (deprecated)
10574 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
10575 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
10576 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010577
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010578 ACL derivatives :
10579 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010581res.comp : boolean
10582 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
10583 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
10584 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010586res.comp_algo : string
10587 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
10588 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
10589 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010591res.cook([<name>]) : string
10592scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10593 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10594 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
10595 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020010596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010597 ACL derivatives :
10598 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020010599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010600res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10601scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10602 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
10603 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
10604 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010606res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
10607scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10608 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10609 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
10610 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010612res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10613 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
10614 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
10615 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
10616 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
10617 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
10618 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
10619 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
10620 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
10621 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010623res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10624 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
10625 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10626 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
10627 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
10628 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010630res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10631shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
10632 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
10633 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
10634 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
10635 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
10636 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
10637 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
10638 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
10639 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010641 ACL derivatives :
10642 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
10643 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
10644 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
10645 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
10646 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
10647 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
10648 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
10649 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
10650
10651res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10652shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10653 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
10654 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10655 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
10656 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
10657 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010659res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
10660shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
10661 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
10662 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
10663 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
10664 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
10665 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
10666 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010668res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
10669shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
10670 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
10671 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
10672 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
10673 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10674 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
10675 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010010676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010677res.ver : string
10678resp_ver : string (deprecated)
10679 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
10680 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010682 ACL derivatives :
10683 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010010684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010685set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10686 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10687 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
10688 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
10689 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010691 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
10692 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010694 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010696status : integer
10697 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
10698 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
10699 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010701url : string
10702 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
10703 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
10704 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
10705 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
10706 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
10707 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
10708 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010709
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010710 ACL derivatives :
10711 url : exact string match
10712 url_beg : prefix match
10713 url_dir : subdir match
10714 url_dom : domain match
10715 url_end : suffix match
10716 url_len : length match
10717 url_reg : regex match
10718 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010720url_ip : ip
10721 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
10722 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
10723 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
10724 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
10725 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
10726 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
10727 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010729url_port : integer
10730 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
10731 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
10732 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
10733 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010735urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
10736url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
10737 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
10738 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
10739 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
10740 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
10741 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
10742 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
10743 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
10744 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
10745 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010747 ACL derivatives :
10748 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
10749 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
10750 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
10751 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
10752 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
10753 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
10754 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
10755 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010756
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010758 Example :
10759 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
10760 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
10761 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
10762 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010764urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
10765 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
10766 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
10767 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020010768
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010010769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200107707.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010771---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010010772
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010773Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
10774every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010775order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010010776
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010777ACL name Equivalent to Usage
10778---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010779FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020010780HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010781HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
10782HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010783HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
10784HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
10785HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
10786HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
10787LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010788METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
10789METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
10790METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
10791METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
10792METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
10793METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010794RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010795REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010796TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010797WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
10798---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010010799
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010800
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200108018. Logging
10802----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010803
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010804One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
10805provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
10806very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
10807provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
10808state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010809to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010810headers.
10811
10812In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
10813about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
10814send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
10815
10816 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
10817 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
10818 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
10819 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
10820 at the termination.
10821
10822The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
10823allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
10824as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
10825while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
10826real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
10827delay.
10828
10829
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200108308.1. Log levels
10831---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010832
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090010833TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010834source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090010835HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
10836in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
10837track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
10838syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
10839about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010840
10841
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200108428.2. Log formats
10843----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010844
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010845HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090010846and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
10847slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
10848options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010849
10850 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
10851 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
10852 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
10853 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
10854 extents.
10855
10856 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
10857 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
10858 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
10859 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
10860 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
10861
10862 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
10863 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
10864 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
10865 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
10866 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
10867
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020010868 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
10869 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
10870 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
10871 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
10872
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010873 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
10874
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010875Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
10876specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
10877field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
10878servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
10879always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
10880identifier.
10881
10882Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
10883 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
10884 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
10885 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
10886 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
10887
10888
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200108898.2.1. Default log format
10890-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010891
10892This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
10893as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
10894format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
10895
10896 Example :
10897 listen www
10898 mode http
10899 log global
10900 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
10901
10902 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
10903 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
10904 (www/HTTP)
10905
10906 Field Format Extract from the example above
10907 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
10908 2 'Connect from' Connect from
10909 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
10910 4 'to' to
10911 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
10912 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
10913
10914Detailed fields description :
10915 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
10916 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
10917 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
10918 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
10919 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
10920 and processed the connection.
10921 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
10922
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010923In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
10924"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
10925connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
10926
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010927It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
10928will eventually disappear.
10929
10930
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200109318.2.2. TCP log format
10932---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010933
10934The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
10935is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
10936information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
10937counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
10938emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
10939environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
10940the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
10941sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010942specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
10943not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
10944fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
10945marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010946
10947 Example :
10948 frontend fnt
10949 mode tcp
10950 option tcplog
10951 log global
10952 default_backend bck
10953
10954 backend bck
10955 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
10956
10957 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
10958 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
10959 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
10960
10961 Field Format Extract from the example above
10962 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
10963 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
10964 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
10965 4 frontend_name fnt
10966 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
10967 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
10968 7 bytes_read* 212
10969 8 termination_state --
10970 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
10971 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
10972
10973Detailed fields description :
10974 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010975 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
10976 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
10977 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
10978 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
10979 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010980
10981 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010982 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
10983 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
10984 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010985
10986 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
10987 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
10988 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
10989 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
10990
10991 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
10992 and processed the connection.
10993
10994 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
10995 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
10996 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
10997 applications.
10998
10999 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11000 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11001 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11002 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
11003 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
11004
11005 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11006 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11007 See "Timers" below for more details.
11008
11009 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11010 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11011 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
11012 "Timers" below for more details.
11013
11014 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
11015 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
11016 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11017 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11018 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11019 details.
11020
11021 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
11022 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
11023 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
11024 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
11025 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
11026
11027 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11028 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11029 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
11030 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
11031 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
11032 for more details.
11033
11034 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011035 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011036 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
11037 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
11038 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011039 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011040
11041 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11042 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11043 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11044 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11045 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11046 caused by a denial of service attack.
11047
11048 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11049 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11050 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11051 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11052 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11053 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11054 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11055 denial of service attack.
11056
11057 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11058 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11059 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11060 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11061 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11062 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11063 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11064 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
11065 be processed than on other servers.
11066
11067 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11068 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11069 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11070 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11071 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11072 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11073 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11074 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11075 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11076 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11077 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11078 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11079 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11080
11081 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11082 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11083 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11084 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11085 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11086 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11087 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11088 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11089
11090 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11091 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11092 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11093 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11094 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11095 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11096 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11097 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11098 occurs.
11099
11100
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111018.2.3. HTTP log format
11102----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011103
11104The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
11105is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
11106the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
11107are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
11108emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
11109generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
11110"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
11111which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011112frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
11113is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011114
11115Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
11116slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
11117with a star ('*') after the field name below.
11118
11119 Example :
11120 frontend http-in
11121 mode http
11122 option httplog
11123 log global
11124 default_backend bck
11125
11126 backend static
11127 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11128
11129 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
11130 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
11131 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011132 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011133
11134 Field Format Extract from the example above
11135 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
11136 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
11137 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
11138 4 frontend_name http-in
11139 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
11140 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
11141 7 status_code 200
11142 8 bytes_read* 2750
11143 9 captured_request_cookie -
11144 10 captured_response_cookie -
11145 11 termination_state ----
11146 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
11147 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11148 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
11149 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
11150 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011151
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011152
11153Detailed fields description :
11154 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011155 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11156 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11157 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11158 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11159 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011160
11161 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011162 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11163 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11164 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011165
11166 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
11167 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
11168 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
11169 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
11170 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
11171
11172 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11173 and processed the connection.
11174
11175 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11176 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11177 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
11178
11179 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11180 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11181 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11182 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
11183 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
11184 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
11185
11186 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
11187 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
11188 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
11189 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
11190 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
11191 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
11192
11193 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11194 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11195 See "Timers" below for more details.
11196
11197 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11198 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11199 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
11200 below for more details.
11201
11202 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
11203 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
11204 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
11205 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
11206 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
11207 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
11208 for more details.
11209
11210 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
11211 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
11212 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11213 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11214 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11215 details.
11216
11217 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
11218 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
11219 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
11220
11221 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
11222 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
11223 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
11224 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
11225 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
11226 overflowing.
11227
11228 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
11229 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
11230 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
11231 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
11232 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
11233 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
11234 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
11235 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11236
11237 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
11238 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
11239 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
11240 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
11241 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
11242 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
11243 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
11244 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11245
11246 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11247 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11248 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
11249 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
11250 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
11251 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
11252 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
11253
11254 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011255 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011256 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
11257 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
11258 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011259 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011260 system.
11261
11262 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11263 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11264 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11265 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11266 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11267 caused by a denial of service attack.
11268
11269 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11270 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11271 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11272 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11273 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11274 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11275 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11276 denial of service attack.
11277
11278 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11279 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11280 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11281 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11282 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11283 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11284 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11285 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
11286 processed than on other servers.
11287
11288 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11289 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11290 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11291 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11292 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11293 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11294 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11295 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11296 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11297 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11298 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11299 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11300 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11301
11302 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11303 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11304 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11305 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11306 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11307 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11308 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11309 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11310
11311 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11312 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11313 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11314 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11315 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11316 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11317 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11318 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11319 occurs.
11320
11321 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
11322 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
11323 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
11324 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
11325 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
11326 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
11327 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
11328 cookies" below for more details.
11329
11330 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
11331 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
11332 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
11333 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
11334 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
11335 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
11336 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
11337 and cookies" below for more details.
11338
11339 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
11340 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
11341 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
11342 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
11343 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
11344 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
11345 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
11346 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
11347
11348
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200113498.2.4. Custom log format
11350------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011351
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011352The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011353mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011354
11355HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
11356Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
11357separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
11358prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
11359
11360Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
11361variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
11362string formats ("Q").
11363
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010011364If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011365as a pattern extraction rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010011366less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
11367the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
11368
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011369Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010011370In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceeded by another '%' resulting
11371in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011372
11373Flags are :
11374 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011375 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011376
11377 Example:
11378
11379 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
11380 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
11381
11382At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
11383
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011384 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
11385 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011386
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011387the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011388
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011389 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020011390 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011391 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011392
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011393and the default TCP format is defined this way :
11394
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011395 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011396 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
11397
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011398Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
11399
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011400 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011401 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011402 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
11403 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
11404 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011405 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
11406 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
11407 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011408 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011409 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011410 | H | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011411 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011412 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080011413 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011414 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
11415 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011416 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011417 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
11418 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011419 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011420 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
11421 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011422 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
11423 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
11424 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011425 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011426 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
11427 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011428 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011429 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
11430 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
11431 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020011432 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011433 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
11434 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
11435 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
11436 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011437 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011438 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011439 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011440 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010011441 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011442 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011443 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
11444 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
11445 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011446 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011447 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
11448 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011449 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011450 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011451 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011452 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011453
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011454 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011455
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010011456
114578.2.5. Error log format
11458-----------------------
11459
11460When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
11461protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
11462By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
11463"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
11464will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
11465logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
11466
11467The format looks like this :
11468
11469 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
11470 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
11471 Connection error during SSL handshake
11472
11473 Field Format Extract from the example above
11474 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
11475 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
11476 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
11477 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
11478 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
11479
11480These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
11481failures.
11482
11483
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114848.3. Advanced logging options
11485-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011486
11487Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
11488just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
11489options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
11490for more information about their usage.
11491
11492
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114938.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
11494------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011495
11496It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
11497haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
11498commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
11499monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
11500ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
11501
11502 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
11503 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
11504 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
11505 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
11506
11507 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
11508 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
11509 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
11510 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
11511 such as other load-balancers.
11512
11513 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
11514 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
11515 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
11516
11517
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115188.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
11519----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011520
11521The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
11522what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
11523or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
11524"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
11525just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
11526log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
11527after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
11528is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
11529with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
11530with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
11531
11532
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115338.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
11534------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011535
11536Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
11537for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
11538"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
11539retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
11540raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
11541a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
11542file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
11543you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
11544"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
11545
11546
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115478.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
11548--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011549
11550Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
11551multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
11552them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
11553"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
11554logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
11555error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
11556and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
11557too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
11558useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
11559alternative.
11560
11561
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115628.4. Timing events
11563------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011564
11565Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
11566reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
11567the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
11568frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
11569mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
11570
11571 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
11572 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
11573 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
11574 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
11575 the client closes prematurely or times out.
11576
11577 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
11578 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
11579 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
11580 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
11581 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
11582
11583 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
11584 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
11585 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
11586 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
11587 connection never established.
11588
11589 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
11590 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
11591 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
11592 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
11593 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
11594 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
11595 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
11596 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
11597 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
11598 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
11599 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
11600
11601 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
11602 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
11603 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
11604 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
11605 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
11606
11607 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
11608
11609 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
11610 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
11611 negative.
11612
11613These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
11614protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
11615that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011616due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011617close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
11618session has been aborted on timeout.
11619
11620Most common cases :
11621
11622 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
11623 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
11624 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
11625 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
11626 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
11627 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
11628 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
11629 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
11630 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020011631 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
11632 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
11633 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011634
11635 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
11636 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
11637 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
11638 of ms on remote networks.
11639
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011640 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
11641 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
11642 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011643
11644 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
11645 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
11646 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
11647 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
11648 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
11649 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
11650 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
11651 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
11652 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
11653 to the server until another one is released.
11654
11655Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
11656
11657 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
11658 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
11659 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
11660
11661 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
11662 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
11663 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
11664
11665 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
11666 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
11667 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
11668 flags.
11669
11670 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
11671 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
11672 Check the session termination flags, then check the
11673 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
11674 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
11675 the client connection was maintained open.
11676
11677 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
11678 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
11679 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
11680 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
11681
11682
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116838.5. Session state at disconnection
11684-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011685
11686TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
11687"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
116882-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
11689each of which has a special meaning :
11690
11691 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
11692 session to terminate :
11693
11694 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
11695
11696 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
11697 server explicitly refused it.
11698
11699 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
11700 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
11701 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
11702 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020011703 (eg: cacheable cookie).
11704
11705 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
11706 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011707
11708 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
11709 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
11710 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
11711 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
11712 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
11713
11714 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
11715 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
11716 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
11717 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
11718 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
11719
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090011720 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
11721 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
11722
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011723 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
11724 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
11725 backup connections when going up.
11726
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020011727 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
11728
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011729 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
11730 send or receive data.
11731
11732 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
11733 send or receive data.
11734
11735 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
11736 with nothing left in the buffers.
11737
11738 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
11739
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010011740 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011741 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
11742
11743 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
11744 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
11745 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
11746 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
11747 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
11748
11749 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
11750 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
11751
11752 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
11753 server (HTTP only).
11754
11755 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
11756
11757 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
11758 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
11759 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
11760
11761 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
11762 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
11763 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
11764
11765 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
11766
11767 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
11768 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
11769
11770 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
11771 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
11772 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
11773
11774 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
11775 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020011776 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
11777 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011778
11779 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
11780 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
11781 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
11782 another server.
11783
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011784 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011785 server.
11786
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011787 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
11788 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
11789 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
11790 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
11791
11792 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
11793 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
11794 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
11795 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
11796
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020011797 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
11798 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
11799 "use-server" rule).
11800
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011801 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
11802
11803 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
11804 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
11805
11806 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
11807
11808 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
11809 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
11810 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
11811
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011812 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
11813 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
11814 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
11815 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
11816 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
11817
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011818 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
11819
11820 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
11821 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
11822
11823 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
11824
11825 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
11826
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011827The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
11828was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011829helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
11830starvation, attacks, etc...
11831
11832The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
11833alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
11834easier finding and understanding.
11835
11836 Flags Reason
11837
11838 -- Normal termination.
11839
11840 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
11841 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
11842 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
11843 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
11844
11845 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
11846 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
11847 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
11848 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
11849 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
11850 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011851
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011852 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
11853 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011854 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011855
11856 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
11857 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
11858 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
11859
11860 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
11861 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
11862 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
11863 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
11864 the server takes too long to respond.
11865
11866 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
11867 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
11868 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
11869 long a time to respond.
11870
11871 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
11872 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
11873 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
11874 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
11875 and the client.
11876
11877 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
11878 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
11879 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
11880 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
11881 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
11882 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
11883
11884 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
11885 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011886 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
11887 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
11888 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
11889 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011890
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020011891 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
11892 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
11893
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011894 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011895 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
11896 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
11897 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
11898 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
11899 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
11900
11901 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
11902 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
11903 503 or 504 here.
11904
11905 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
11906 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
11907 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
11908 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
11909 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
11910
11911 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
11912 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011913 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011914 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
11915 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
11916
11917 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
11918 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
11919 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
11920 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
11921 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
11922 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
11923 between haproxy and the server.
11924
11925 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
11926 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
11927 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
11928 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
11929 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
11930 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
11931 solution is to fix the application.
11932
11933 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
11934 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
11935 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
11936 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
11937 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
11938 external attacks.
11939
11940 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
11941 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011942 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011943 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
11944 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
11945
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010011946 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
11947 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
11948 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020011949 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
11950 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010011951
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011952 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
11953 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
11954 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
11955 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010011956 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
11957 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
11958 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
11959 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
11960 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011961
11962 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
11963 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
11964 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
11965 returned an HTTP 403 error.
11966
11967 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
11968 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
11969 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
11970 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
11971
11972 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
11973 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
11974 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
11975 only be solved by proper system tuning.
11976
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011977The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
11978persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
11979important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
11980re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
11981
11982 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
11983
11984 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
11985 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
11986 set on a GET request.
11987
11988 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
11989 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011990 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011991 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
11992
11993 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
11994 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
11995 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
11996
11997 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
11998 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
11999 already got a cookie.
12000
12001 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12002 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
12003 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
12004 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
12005 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
12006
12007 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12008 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12009 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12010
12011 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
12012 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12013 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12014
12015 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
12016 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
12017
12018 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
12019 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
12020 then advertised in the response.
12021
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012022
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120238.6. Non-printable characters
12024-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012025
12026In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
12027consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
12028converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
12029prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
12030being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
12031escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
12032is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
12033'}' when logging headers.
12034
12035Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
12036issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
12037containing spaces is "User-Agent".
12038
12039Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
12040the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
12041performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
12042
12043
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120448.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
12045---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012046
12047Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
12048achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012049section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012050cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
12051the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
12052the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012053locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012054not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
12055user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
12056a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
12057wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
12058
12059 Examples :
12060 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
12061 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
12062
12063 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
12064 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
12065
12066
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120678.8. Capturing HTTP headers
12068---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012069
12070Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
12071proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
12072the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
12073server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
12074
12075Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
12076response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012077section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012078
12079It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012080time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
12081appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012082are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
12083and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
12084follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
12085request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
12086in the logs.
12087
12088 Example :
12089 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
12090 listen proxy-out
12091 mode http
12092 option httplog
12093 option logasap
12094 log global
12095 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
12096
12097 # log the name of the virtual server
12098 capture request header Host len 20
12099
12100 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
12101 capture request header Content-Length len 10
12102
12103 # log the beginning of the referrer
12104 capture request header Referer len 20
12105
12106 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
12107 capture response header Server len 20
12108
12109 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
12110 capture response header Content-Length len 10
12111
12112 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
12113 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
12114
12115 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
12116 capture response header Via len 20
12117
12118 # log the URL location during a redirection
12119 capture response header Location len 20
12120
12121 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
12122 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
12123 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12124 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
12125 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
12126
12127 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12128 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12129 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12130 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012131 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012132
12133 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12134 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12135 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12136 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
12137 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012138 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012139
12140
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121418.9. Examples of logs
12142---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012143
12144These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
12145them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
12146reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
12147
12148 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
12149 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12150 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12151
12152 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
12153 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
12154
12155 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
12156 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
12157 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12158
12159 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
12160 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
12161
12162 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
12163 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12164 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
12165
12166 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012167 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012168 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
12169 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
12170
12171 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
12172 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
12173 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
12174
12175 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
12176 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020012177 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012178 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
12179 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
12180 to return the 502 and not the server.
12181
12182 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012183 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012184
12185 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
12186 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
12187 Nothing was sent to any server.
12188
12189 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
12190 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
12191
12192 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
12193 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
12194 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
12195 send a 408 return code to the client.
12196
12197 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
12198 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
12199
12200 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
12201 5 seconds ("c----").
12202
12203 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
12204 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012205 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012206
12207 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012208 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012209 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
12210 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
12211 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
12212 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
12213 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012214
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012215
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122169. Statistics and monitoring
12217----------------------------
12218
12219It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
12220mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
12221CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
12222Unix socket.
12223
12224
122259.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012226---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012227
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010012228The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
12229page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
12230
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012231 0. pxname: proxy name
12232 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
12233 for server)
12234 2. qcur: current queued requests
12235 3. qmax: max queued requests
12236 4. scur: current sessions
12237 5. smax: max sessions
12238 6. slim: sessions limit
12239 7. stot: total sessions
12240 8. bin: bytes in
12241 9. bout: bytes out
12242 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012243 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012244 12. ereq: request errors
12245 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012246 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012247 15. wretr: retries (warning)
12248 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010012249 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012250 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
12251 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
12252 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
12253 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
12254 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
12255 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
12256 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
12257 25. qlimit: queue limit
12258 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
12259 27. iid: unique proxy id
12260 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
12261 29. throttle: warm up status
12262 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
12263 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020012264 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020012265 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
12266 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
12267 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012268 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012269 UNK -> unknown
12270 INI -> initializing
12271 SOCKERR -> socket error
12272 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
12273 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
12274 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
12275 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
12276 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
12277 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
12278 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
12279 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
12280 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
12281 disable-on-404
12282 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
12283 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
12284 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012285 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
12286 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012287 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
12288 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
12289 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
12290 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
12291 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
12292 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012293 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
12294 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
12295 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
12296 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012297 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
12298 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau55058a72012-11-21 08:27:21 +010012299 51. comp_in: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
12300 52. comp_out: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
12301 53. comp_byp: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor (CPU/BW limit)
Willy Tarreau11d4ec82012-11-26 00:49:03 +010012302 54. comp_rsp: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012303
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012304
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123059.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012306-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012307
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020012308The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
12309necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
12310A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
12311issuing commands by hand :
12312
12313 global
12314 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12315 stats timeout 2m
12316
12317It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
12318the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
12319never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
12320situations :
12321
12322 global
12323 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12324 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
12325 stats timeout 2m
12326
12327To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
12328swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
12329to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
12330syntaxes we'll use are the following :
12331
12332 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
12333 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
12334
12335The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
12336script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
12337for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
12338
12339The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
12340that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
12341editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
12342(eg: watch a counter).
12343
12344The socket supports two operation modes :
12345 - interactive
12346 - non-interactive
12347
12348The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
12349this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
12350sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
12351mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
12352commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
12353example :
12354
12355 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
12356
12357The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
12358entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
12359for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
12360sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
12361"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
12362after processing the last command of the same line.
12363
12364For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
12365"prompt" command :
12366
12367 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
12368 prompt
12369 > show info
12370 ...
12371 >
12372
12373Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
12374delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
12375that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
12376parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012377
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012378It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
12379on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
12380own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012381
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020012382The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
12383If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
12384all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
12385it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
12386
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012387add map <map> <key> <value>
12388 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
12389 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
12390 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation.
12391
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012392clear counters
12393 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
12394 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
12395 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
12396 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
12397 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
12398
12399clear counters all
12400 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
12401 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
12402 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
12403
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012404clear map <map>
12405 Remove all entries from the map <map>.
12406
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012407clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
12408 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
12409
12410 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
12411 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
12412 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
12413 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
12414 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
12415 later after the session ends is usual enough.
12416
12417 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
12418
12419 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
12420 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
12421 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
12422 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
12423 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
12424 the ACLs :
12425
12426 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
12427 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
12428 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
12429 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
12430 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
12431 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
12432
12433 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090012434 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
12435 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012436
12437 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012438 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012439 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012440 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
12441 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
12442 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12443 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012444
12445 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12446
12447 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012448 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012449 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12450 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012451 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12452 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12453 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012454
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090012455enable agent <backend>/<server>
12456 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
12457
12458 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
12459 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
12460 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
12461 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
12462 re-enabled using enable agent.
12463
12464 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
12465 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
12466 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
12467 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
12468 otherwise unchanged.
12469
12470 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
12471 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
12472 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
12473
12474 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12475 level "admin".
12476
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012477del map <map> <key>
12478 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
12479
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012480disable frontend <frontend>
12481 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
12482 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
12483 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
12484 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
12485 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
12486 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
12487 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
12488 on the stats page.
12489
12490 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12491 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12492
12493 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12494 level "admin".
12495
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012496disable server <backend>/<server>
12497 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
12498 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
12499 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
12500 during the maintenance.
12501
12502 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
12503 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
12504
12505 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012506 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012507
12508 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12509 level "admin".
12510
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090012511enable agent <backend>/<server>
12512 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
12513
12514 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
12515 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
12516
12517 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12518 level "admin".
12519
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012520enable frontend <frontend>
12521 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
12522 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
12523 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
12524 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
12525 which was disabled.
12526
12527 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12528 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12529
12530 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12531 level "admin".
12532
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012533enable server <backend>/<server>
12534 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
12535 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
12536
12537 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012538 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012539
12540 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12541 level "admin".
12542
12543get weight <backend>/<server>
12544 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
12545 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
12546 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
12547 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
12548 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012549 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012550
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012551help
12552 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
12553 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012554
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012555prompt
12556 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
12557 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
12558 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
12559 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
12560 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
12561 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
12562 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
12563 command.
12564
12565quit
12566 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012567
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012568set map <map> <key> <value>
12569 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. The new value
12570 is <value>.
12571
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020012572set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020012573 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
12574 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
12575 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
12576 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
12577 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020012578 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
12579 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12580
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020012581set maxconn global <maxconn>
12582 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
12583 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
12584 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
12585 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
12586 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
12587 setting.
12588
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020012589set rate-limit connections global <value>
12590 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
12591 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
12592 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
12593 is passed in number of connections per second.
12594
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010012595set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
12596 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
12597 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010012598 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
12599 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010012600
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020012601set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020012602 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
12603 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
12604 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
12605 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020012606 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
12607 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020012608
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012609set timeout cli <delay>
12610 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
12611 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
12612 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
12613
12614set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
12615 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
12616 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090012617 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
12618 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
12619 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
12620 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
12621 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
12622 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
12623 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
12624 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
12625 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
12626 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
12627 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
12628 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
12629 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012630
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012631show errors [<iid>]
12632 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
12633 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020012634 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
12635 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
12636 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012637
12638 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
12639 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
12640 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
12641 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
12642 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
12643 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
12644 are reported too.
12645
12646 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
12647 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
12648 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
12649 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
12650 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
12651 code.
12652
12653 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
12654 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
12655 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
12656 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
12657 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
12658 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
12659 line.
12660
12661 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012662 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12663 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012664 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
12665 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
12666
12667 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
12668 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
12669 00038 Location: blah\r\n
12670 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
12671 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
12672 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
12673 00204+ minal\r\n
12674 00211 \r\n
12675
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012676 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012677 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
12678 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
12679 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
12680 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
12681 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
12682 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012683
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012684show info
12685 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
12686
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012687show map [<map>]
12688 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
12689 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped.
12690
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012691show sess
12692 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020012693 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
12694 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
12695
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010012696show sess <id>
12697 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
12698 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
12699 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
12700 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
12701 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Willy Tarreau76153662012-11-26 01:16:39 +010012702 freely evolve depending on demands. The special id "all" dumps the states of
12703 all sessions, which can be avoided as much as possible as it is highly CPU
12704 intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012705
12706show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
12707 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
12708 possible to dump only selected items :
12709 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
12710 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
12711 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
12712 for example:
12713 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
12714 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
12715 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
12716
12717 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012718 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
12719 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012720 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
12721 Release_date: 2009/09/23
12722 Nbproc: 1
12723 Process_num: 1
12724 (...)
12725
12726 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
12727 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
12728 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
12729 (...)
12730 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
12731
12732 $
12733
12734 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
12735 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
12736 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
12737 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012738 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012739
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012740show table
12741 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
12742 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
12743 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
12744 entries currently in use.
12745
12746 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012747 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012748 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
12749 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012750
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012751show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012752 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
12753 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
12754 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012755 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
12756
12757 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
12758 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
12759 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
12760 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
12761 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
12762
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012763 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
12764 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
12765 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
12766 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
12767 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
12768 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
12769
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012770
12771 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090012772 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
12773 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012774
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012775 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012776 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012777 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012778 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
12779 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
12780 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12781 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012782
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012783 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012784 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012785 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12786 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012787
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012788 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
12789 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012790 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012791 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12792 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012793
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012794 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
12795 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012796 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012797 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12798 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
12799
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012800 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
12801 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
12802 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
12803 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
12804 time goes, the average event rate drops.
12805
12806 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
12807 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
12808 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012809 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
12810 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012811 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
12812 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020012813
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012814shutdown frontend <frontend>
12815 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
12816 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
12817 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
12818 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
12819 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
12820 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
12821 once it is terminated.
12822
12823 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12824 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12825
12826 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12827 level "admin".
12828
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020012829shutdown session <id>
12830 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
12831 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
12832 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
12833 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
12834 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
12835 flag in the logs.
12836
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020012837shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
12838 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
12839 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
12840 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
12841 'K' flag in the logs.
12842
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012843/*
12844 * Local variables:
12845 * fill-column: 79
12846 * End:
12847 */